blob: afffc63ebe933d951f577638ace342623434bad1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau04df1122011-04-08 00:56:41 +02007 2011/04/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
516 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
517 writeable).
518
519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520
521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
524
525 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200526 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
527 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
528 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
529 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
530 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532
533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
534
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100535log-send-hostname [<string>]
536 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
537 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
538 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
539 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
540 the logs.
541
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000542log-tag <string>
543 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
544 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
545 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
546 running on the same host.
547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548nbproc <number>
549 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
550 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
551 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
552 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
553 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
554
555pidfile <pidfile>
556 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
557 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
558 starting the process. See also "daemon".
559
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200560stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200561 [level <level>]
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
564 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100565 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200566 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
567
568 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
569 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
570 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
571 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
572 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
573
574 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
575 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
576 counters).
577
578 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
579 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100580
581 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
582 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
583 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
584 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
585 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
586 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
587 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200588
589stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
590 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
591 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100592 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats maxconn <connections>
595 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
596 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598uid <number>
599 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
600 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
601 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
602 one. See also "gid" and "user".
603
604ulimit-n <number>
605 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
606 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
607 option.
608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100609unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
610 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
611
612 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
613 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
614 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
615 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
616 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
617 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
618 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
619 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
620 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
621 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623user <user name>
624 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
625 See also "uid" and "group".
626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200627node <name>
628 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
629
630 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
631 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
632 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
633 traffic.
634
635description <text>
636 Add a text that describes the instance.
637
638 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
639 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
640 "<" and ">" characters.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644-----------------------
645
646maxconn <number>
647 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
648 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
649 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
650 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
651
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652maxpipes <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
654 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
655 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
656 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
657 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
658 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660noepoll
661 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
662 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
663 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
664
665nokqueue
666 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
667 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
668 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
669
670nopoll
671 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
672 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100673 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
675 "nokqueue".
676
677nosepoll
678 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
680 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100682nosplice
683 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
684 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
685 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100686 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100687 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
688 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
689 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
690 "option splice-response".
691
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200692spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
693 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
694 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
695 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
696 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
697 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
698
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200699tune.bufsize <number>
700 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
701 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
702 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
703 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
704 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
705 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
706 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
707 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
708
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200709tune.chksize <number>
710 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
711 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
712 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
713 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
714 checks whenever possible.
715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100716tune.maxaccept <number>
717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
718 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
719 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100720 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100721 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
722 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100723 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100724 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
725
726tune.maxpollevents <number>
727 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
728 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
729 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
730 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
731 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
732
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200733tune.maxrewrite <number>
734 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
735 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
736 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
737 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
738 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
739 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
740 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
741 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
742 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
743 bufsize.
744
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100745tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
746tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
748 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754
755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
760 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
766 notifying haproxy again.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693.3. Debugging
770--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
772debug
773 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
774 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
775 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
776 system startup.
777
778quiet
779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
780 line argument "-q".
781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007833.4. Userlists
784--------------
785It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
786http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
787it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
788
789userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
792
793group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100794 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100795 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
796 proceeded by "users" keyword.
797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
799 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
801 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100802 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
803 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100804 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
805 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
806
807
808 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 userlist L1
810 group G1 users tiger,scott
811 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
814 user scott insecure-password elgato
815 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 userlist L2
818 group G1
819 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100821 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
822 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
823 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824
825 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200827
8283.5. Peers
829--------------
830It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
831haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
832pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
833identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
834or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
835Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
836known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
837the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
838process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
839during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
840tables.
841
842peers <peersect>
843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
845
846peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
847 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
848 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
849 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
850 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
851 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
852 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
853
854 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
855 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
856
857 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
858 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
859 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
860 across all peers.
861
862Example:
863 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
865 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
866 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200867
868 backend mybackend
869 mode tcp
870 balance roundrobin
871 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
872 stick on src
873
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100874 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
875 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
882 - defaults <name>
883 - frontend <name>
884 - backend <name>
885 - listen <name>
886
887A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
888its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
889section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100890section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
892A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
893connections.
894
895A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
896to forward incoming connections.
897
898A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
899parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100901All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
902'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
903case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
904
905Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
906logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
907proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
908However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
909name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
910
911Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
912and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
915modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
916arbitrary criteria.
917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
920--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
923limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
924they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
925limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200927option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200928and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
929with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
930specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100933 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
934------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
935acl - X X X
936appsession - - X X
937backlog X X X -
938balance X - X X
939bind - X X -
940bind-process X X X X
941block - X X X
942capture cookie - X X -
943capture request header - X X -
944capture response header - X X -
945clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
947cookie X - X X
948default-server X - X X
949default_backend X X X -
950description - X X X
951disabled X X X X
952dispatch - - X X
953enabled X X X X
954errorfile X X X X
955errorloc X X X X
956errorloc302 X X X X
957-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
958errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200959force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960fullconn X - X X
961grace X X X X
962hash-type X - X X
963http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100964http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200965http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966http-request - X X X
967id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200968ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969log X X X X
970maxconn X X X -
971mode X X X X
972monitor fail - X X -
973monitor-net X X X -
974monitor-uri X X X -
975option abortonclose (*) X - X X
976option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
977option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
978option allbackups (*) X - X X
979option checkcache (*) X - X X
980option clitcpka (*) X X X -
981option contstats (*) X X X -
982option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
983option dontlognull (*) X X X -
984option forceclose (*) X X X X
985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
986option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200987option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200988option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100989option http-server-close (*) X X X X
990option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
991option httpchk X - X X
992option httpclose (*) X X X X
993option httplog X X X X
994option http_proxy (*) X X X X
995option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200996option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
998option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
999option logasap (*) X X X -
1000option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001001option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002option nolinger (*) X X X X
1003option originalto X X X X
1004option persist (*) X - X X
1005option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001006option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001007option smtpchk X - X X
1008option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1009option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1010option splice-request (*) X X X X
1011option splice-response (*) X X X X
1012option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1013option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1014-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1015option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1016option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1017option tcpka X X X X
1018option tcplog X X X X
1019option transparent (*) X - X X
1020persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1021rate-limit sessions X X X -
1022redirect - X X X
1023redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1024redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1025reqadd - X X X
1026reqallow - X X X
1027reqdel - X X X
1028reqdeny - X X X
1029reqiallow - X X X
1030reqidel - X X X
1031reqideny - X X X
1032reqipass - X X X
1033reqirep - X X X
1034reqisetbe - X X X
1035reqitarpit - X X X
1036reqpass - X X X
1037reqrep - X X X
1038-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1039reqsetbe - X X X
1040reqtarpit - X X X
1041retries X - X X
1042rspadd - X X X
1043rspdel - X X X
1044rspdeny - X X X
1045rspidel - X X X
1046rspideny - X X X
1047rspirep - X X X
1048rsprep - X X X
1049server - - X X
1050source X - X X
1051srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001052stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001053stats auth X - X X
1054stats enable X - X X
1055stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001056stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001057stats realm X - X X
1058stats refresh X - X X
1059stats scope X - X X
1060stats show-desc X - X X
1061stats show-legends X - X X
1062stats show-node X - X X
1063stats uri X - X X
1064-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1065stick match - - X X
1066stick on - - X X
1067stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001068stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001069stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001070tcp-request connection - X X -
1071tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001072tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001073tcp-response content - - X X
1074tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001075timeout check X - X X
1076timeout client X X X -
1077timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1078timeout connect X - X X
1079timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1080timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1081timeout http-request X X X X
1082timeout queue X - X X
1083timeout server X - X X
1084timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1085timeout tarpit X X X X
1086transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1087use_backend - X X -
1088------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1089 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1093---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001094
1095This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1096
1097
1098acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1099 Declare or complete an access list.
1100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1101 no | yes | yes | yes
1102 Example:
1103 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1104 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1105 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001107 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
1109
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001110appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1111 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001112 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1114 no | no | yes | yes
1115 Arguments :
1116 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1117 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1118
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001119 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001120 checked in each cookie value.
1121
1122 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1123 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1124 milliseconds.
1125
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001126 request-learn
1127 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1128 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1129 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1130 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1131 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1132 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1133
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001134 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1135 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1136 data following this prefix.
1137
1138 Example :
1139 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1140
1141 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1142 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1143
1144 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1145 2 modes are currently supported :
1146 - path-parameters :
1147 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1148 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1149 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1150 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1151 - query-string :
1152 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1153 query string.
1154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001155 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1156 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1157 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1158 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001159 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1160 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1161 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001162 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1163 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1164
1165 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1166
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001167 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1168 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1169 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001171 Example :
1172 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1173
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001174 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1175 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001176
1177
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001178backlog <conns>
1179 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1181 yes | yes | yes | no
1182 Arguments :
1183 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1184 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1185 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1186
1187 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1188 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1189 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1190 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1191 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1192 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1193 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1194 backlog parameter.
1195
1196 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1197 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1198 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1199
1200 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1201
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001204balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1207 yes | no | yes | yes
1208 Arguments :
1209 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1210 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1211 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1212 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1213
1214 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1215 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1216 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1217 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001218 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1219 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1220 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1221 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1222 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1223 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1224 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1225 it, so that you don't worry.
1226
1227 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1228 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1229 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1230 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1231 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1232 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1233 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1234 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001235
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001236 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1237 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1238 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1239 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1240 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1241 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1242 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1243 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001245 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1246 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1247 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1248 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1249 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1250 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1251 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1252 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001253 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001255 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1256 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1257 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001258
1259 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1260 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1261 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1262 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1263 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1264 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1265 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001266 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1267 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1268 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001270 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1271 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1272 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1273 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1274 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1275 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1276 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1277 URIs start with a leading "/".
1278
1279 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1280 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1281 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1282 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1283
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001285 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1286
1287 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1288 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001289 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1290 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001291 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1292 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1293 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1294 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1295 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1296 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1297 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1298 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1299 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1300 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1301 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1302 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1303 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1304 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1305 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1306 be randomly balanced if at all.
1307
1308 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1309 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1310 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1311 server will receive the request.
1312
1313 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1314 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1315 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1316 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1317 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001318 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1319 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1320 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001321
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001322 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001323 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1324 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001325 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001326 algorithm is applied instead.
1327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001328 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001329 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1330 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1331 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1332
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001333 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1334 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1335 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1336
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001337 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001338 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001339 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1340 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1341 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1342 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1343 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1344 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001345 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001346 used instead.
1347
1348 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1349 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1350 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1351 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1352
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001353 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1354 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1355 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1356
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001357 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001359 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001360 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1361 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001362
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001363 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001364 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001365
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001366 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1367 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1368 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001369
1370 Examples :
1371 balance roundrobin
1372 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001373 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001374 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1375 balance hdr(host)
1376 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001377
1378 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1379 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001381 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001382 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1383 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1384 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1385 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1386
1387 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1388 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1389 defaults to 16 kB.
1390
1391 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1392 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1393
1394 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1395 Round Robin.
1396
1397 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1398 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1399 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1400 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1401
1402 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1403
1404 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001405 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001406 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1407 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1408 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001409
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001410 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1411 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001412
1413
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001414bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1415bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1416bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1417bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1418bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1419bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1420bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001421bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001422bind /<path> [, ...]
1423bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1424bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1425bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1428 no | yes | yes | no
1429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001430 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1431 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1432 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1433 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001434 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001435
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001436 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1437 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001438 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1439 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1440 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001441 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1442 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1443 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1444 the range.
1445
1446 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1447 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1448 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1449 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1450 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1451 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1452 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1453 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1454 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001456 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1457 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1458 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1459 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1460 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1461 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1462 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1463 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1464
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001465 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1466 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1467 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1468 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1469 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1470 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1471 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1472 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001473 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1474 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001475
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001476 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1477 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1478 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1479 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1480 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1481 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001482 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1483 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1484 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1485 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1486 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1487 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1488 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1489 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001490
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001491 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1492 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1493 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1494 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001495
1496 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1497
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001498 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1499 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1500 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1501 simply ignore this.
1502
1503 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1504 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1505 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1506 simply ignore this.
1507
1508 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1509 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1510 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1511 this.
1512
1513 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1514 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1515 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1516 this.
1517
1518 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1519 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1520 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1521 this.
1522
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001523 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1524 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1525 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001526 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001527 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1528 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1529 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1530 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001531 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1532 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001534 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001535 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1536 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1537 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1538 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1539 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1540 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1541 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1542 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1543 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1544 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1545 with front firewalls which would see an established
1546 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1547
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001548 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1549 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1550 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1551 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1552 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1553 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1554 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1555 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1556 This keyword combined with support from external components
1557 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1558 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1559 not even always usable.
1560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1562 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1563 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1564 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1565 in a frontend.
1566
1567 Example :
1568 listen http_proxy
1569 bind :80,:443
1570 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001571 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001572
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001573 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001574 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575
1576
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001577bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1578 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1580 yes | yes | yes | yes
1581 Arguments :
1582 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1583 may be used to override a default value.
1584
1585 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1586 option may be combined with other numbers.
1587
1588 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1589 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1590 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1591 missing from all processes.
1592
1593 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1594 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1595 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1596 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1597
1598 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1599 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1600 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1601 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1602 and 'even' instances.
1603
1604 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1605 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1606 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1607 32.
1608
1609 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1610 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1611
1612 Example :
1613 listen app_ip1
1614 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001615 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001616
1617 listen app_ip2
1618 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001619 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001620
1621 listen management
1622 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001623 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001624
1625 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1626
1627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628block { if | unless } <condition>
1629 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1631 no | yes | yes | yes
1632
1633 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1634 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001635 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1637 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1638 "block" statements per instance.
1639
1640 Example:
1641 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1642 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1643 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1644 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001646 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001647
1648
1649capture cookie <name> len <length>
1650 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1652 no | yes | yes | no
1653 Arguments :
1654 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1655 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1656 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1657 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1658 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1659
1660 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1661 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1662 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1663 right if it exceeds <length>.
1664
1665 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1666 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1667 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1668 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1669
1670 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1671 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1672 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1673
1674 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1675 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1676 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1677 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001678 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1680
1681 Example:
1682 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1683
1684 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001685 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
1687
1688capture request header <name> len <length>
1689 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1691 no | yes | yes | no
1692 Arguments :
1693 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001694 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1696 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1697 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1698
1699 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1700 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1701 it exceeds <length>.
1702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001703 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1705 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001706 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1707 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1708 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1709 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001710 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001711 environments to find where the request came from.
1712
1713 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1714 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1715 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1716 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717
1718 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1719 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1720 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1721 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1722
1723 Example:
1724 capture request header Host len 15
1725 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1726 capture request header Referrer len 15
1727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001728 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001729 about logging.
1730
1731
1732capture response header <name> len <length>
1733 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1735 no | yes | yes | no
1736 Arguments :
1737 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001738 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1740 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1741 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1742
1743 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1744 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1745 it exceeds <length>.
1746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001747 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1749 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1750 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001751 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1752 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1753 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1754 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1757 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1758 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1759 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1760
1761 Example:
1762 capture response header Content-length len 9
1763 capture response header Location len 15
1764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001765 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 about logging.
1767
1768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001769clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1772 yes | yes | yes | no
1773 Arguments :
1774 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1776 as explained at the top of this document.
1777
1778 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1779 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1780 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1781 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1782 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1783 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1784 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1785 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001786 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1788 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1789
1790 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1791 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1792 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1793 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1794 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1795 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1796
1797 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1798 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1799
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001800 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1801 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802
1803
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001804contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1807 yes | no | yes | yes
1808 Arguments :
1809 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1810 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1811 as explained at the top of this document.
1812
1813 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001814 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001815 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1817 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1818 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1819 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1820
1821 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1822 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1823 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1824 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1825 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1826 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1827
1828 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1829 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1830 instead.
1831
1832 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1833 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1834
1835
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001836cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001837 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001838 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | no | yes | yes
1842 Arguments :
1843 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1844 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1845 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1846 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1847 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1848 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1849 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1850 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1851 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1852
1853 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1854 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1855 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1856 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1857 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1858 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1859 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1860 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1861 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1862 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1863 "insert" and "prefix".
1864
1865 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001866 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001867
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001868 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001869 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1870 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1871 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1872 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1873 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1874 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1875 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1876 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1877 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1878 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879
1880 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1881 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1882 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1883 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1884 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1885 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1886 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1887 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1888 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1889 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1890 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1891
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001892 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1893 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1894 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001895 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1896 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1897 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1898 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1901 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1902 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1903 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1904 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1905 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1906 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1907 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1908 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1909
1910 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1911 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1912 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1913 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1914 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1915 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1916 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1917 persistence cookie in the cache.
1918 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1919
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001920 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1921 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1922 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1923 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1924 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1925 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1926 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1927 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1928 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1929 they logout.
1930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001931 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001932 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001933 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1934 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1935 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1936 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1937 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1938 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001939
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001940 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1941 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1942 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1943 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1944 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1945 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1946 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1947 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1948 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1949 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1950 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1951 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1952 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1953 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1954 the site.
1955
1956 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1957 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1958 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1959 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1960 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1961 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1962 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1963 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1964 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1965 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1966 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1967 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1968 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1969 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1970 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1971 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1974 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1975 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1976 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001977
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978 Examples :
1979 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1980 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1981 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001982 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001984 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001985 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001988default-server [param*]
1989 Change default options for a server in a backend
1990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1991 yes | no | yes | yes
1992 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001993 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1994 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1995 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1996 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001997
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001998 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001999 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2000
2001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004default_backend <backend>
2005 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2007 yes | yes | yes | no
2008 Arguments :
2009 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2010
2011 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2012 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2013 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2014 will catch all undetermined requests.
2015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 Example :
2017
2018 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2019 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2020 default_backend dynamic
2021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002022 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
2025disabled
2026 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2028 yes | yes | yes | yes
2029 Arguments : none
2030
2031 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2032 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2033 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2034 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2035 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2036 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2037 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2038
2039 See also : "enabled"
2040
2041
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002042dispatch <address>:<port>
2043 Set a default server address
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 no | no | yes | yes
2046 Arguments : none
2047
2048 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2049 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2050 during start-up.
2051
2052 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2053 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2054 possible with normal servers.
2055
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002056 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002057 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2058 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2059 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2060 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2061
2062 See also : "server"
2063
2064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065enabled
2066 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2068 yes | yes | yes | yes
2069 Arguments : none
2070
2071 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2072 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2073
2074 See also : "disabled"
2075
2076
2077errorfile <code> <file>
2078 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | yes
2081 Arguments :
2082 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002083 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002086 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002088 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2089 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090
2091 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2092 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2093 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2094
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002095 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2098 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2099 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2100 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2101
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002102 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2103 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2104 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2105 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2106 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2107 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2110 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2111 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002112 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2114
2115 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2116
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002117 Example :
2118 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2119 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2120 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2121
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002122
2123errorloc <code> <url>
2124errorloc302 <code> <url>
2125 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2127 yes | yes | yes | yes
2128 Arguments :
2129 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002130 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002131
2132 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2133 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2134 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2135 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2136 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2137
2138 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2139 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2140 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2141
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002142 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002144 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2145 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2146 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2147 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2148 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2149 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2150 request.
2151
2152 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2153
2154
2155errorloc303 <code> <url>
2156 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2158 yes | yes | yes | yes
2159 Arguments :
2160 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2161 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2162
2163 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2164 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2165 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2166 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2167 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2168
2169 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2170 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2171 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2172
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002173 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002175 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2176 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2177 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2178 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002179 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002180
2181 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2182
2183
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002184force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2185 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2187 no | yes | yes | yes
2188
2189 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2190 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2191 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2192 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2193 marked down for maintenance operations.
2194
2195 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2196 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2197 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2198 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2199 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2200 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2201 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2202 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2203 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2204
2205 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2206 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2207 is used.
2208
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002209 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002210 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002211
2212
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002213fullconn <conns>
2214 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2216 yes | no | yes | yes
2217 Arguments :
2218 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2219 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2220
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002221 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002222 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002223 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002224 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2225 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2226 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2227 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2228 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002229 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002230
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002231 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2232 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2233 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002235 Example :
2236 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2237 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2238 # connections.
2239 backend dynamic
2240 fullconn 10000
2241 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2242 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2243
2244 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2245
2246
2247grace <time>
2248 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002250 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002251 Arguments :
2252 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2253 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2254 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2255
2256 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2257 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002258 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002259 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2260
2261 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2262 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2263 simplify it.
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002266hash-type <method>
2267 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2269 yes | no | yes | yes
2270 Arguments :
2271 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2272 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2273 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2274 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2275 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2276 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2277 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2278 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2279 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2280
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002281 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2282 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2283 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2284 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2285 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2286 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2287 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2288 this value.
2289
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2296 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2297 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2298 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2299 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2300 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2301 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2302 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2303
2304 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2305
2306 See also : "balance", "server"
2307
2308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309http-check disable-on-404
2310 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002312 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313 Arguments : none
2314
2315 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2316 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2317 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2318 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2319 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2320 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2321 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2322 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002323 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2324 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2325 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2326
2327 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2328
2329
2330http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2331 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2333 no | no | yes | yes
2334 Arguments :
2335 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2336 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2337 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2338 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2339 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2340 details on the supported keywords.
2341
2342 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2343 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2344 with the usual backslash ('\').
2345
2346 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2347 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2348 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2349 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2350 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2351
2352 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2353 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2354 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2355 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2356 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2357
2358 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2359 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2360 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2361 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2362 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2363 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2364
2365 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2366 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2367 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2368 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2369 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2370 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2371 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2372 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2373 trace).
2374
2375 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2376 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2377 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2378 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2379 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2380 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2381 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2382 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2383
2384 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2385 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2386 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2387 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2388 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2389 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2390 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2391 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2392
2393 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2394 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2395
2396 Examples :
2397 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002398 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002399
2400 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002401 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002402
2403 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002404 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002405
2406 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002407 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002408
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002409 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002410
2411
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002412http-check send-state
2413 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2415 yes | no | yes | yes
2416 Arguments : none
2417
2418 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2419 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2420 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2421 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2422 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2423
2424 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2425 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2426 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2427 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2428 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2429 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2430 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2431 checked in multiple backends.
2432
2433 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2434 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2435
2436 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2437 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2438 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2439 one fails.
2440
2441 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2442 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2443 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2444
2445 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2446 server's queue.
2447
2448 Example of a header received by the application server :
2449 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2450 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2451
2452 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2453
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002454http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002455 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002456 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2457
2458 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2459 no | yes | yes | yes
2460
2461 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2462 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2463 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002464 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2465 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002466 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2467
2468 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2469 instance.
2470
2471 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002472 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2473 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2474 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002475
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002476 http-request allow if nagios
2477 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2478 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2479 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002480
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002481 Example:
2482 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002483
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002484 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002485
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002486 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2487 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002489id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002490 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 no | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2496 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2497 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002498
2499
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002500ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2501 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2503 no | yes | yes | yes
2504
2505 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2506 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2507 and running).
2508
2509 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2510 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2511 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2512 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2513 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2514
2515 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2516 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2517
2518 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2519 "unless" condition is met.
2520
2521 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2522
2523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002524log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002525log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002526 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2528 yes | yes | yes | yes
2529 Arguments :
2530 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2531 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2532 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2533 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2534 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2535 parameter.
2536
2537 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2538 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2539
2540 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2541 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2542 standard syslog port).
2543
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002544 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2545 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2546 standard syslog port).
2547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002548 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2549 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2550 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2551 appropriately writeable).
2552
2553 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2554
2555 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2556 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2557 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2558
2559 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2560 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2561 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002562 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2563 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2564 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2565 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2566 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002567
2568 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2569
2570 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2571 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2572 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2573
2574 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002575 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2576 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2577 "info".
2578
2579 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2580 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2581 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2582 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2583
2584 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2585 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002586
2587 Example :
2588 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002589 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2590 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591
2592
2593maxconn <conns>
2594 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2596 yes | yes | yes | no
2597 Arguments :
2598 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2599 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2600 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2601 closes.
2602
2603 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2604 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2605 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2606 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2607 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2608 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2609 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2610 properly tuned.
2611
2612 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2613 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2614 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2615
2616 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2617
2618
2619mode { tcp|http|health }
2620 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2622 yes | yes | yes | yes
2623 Arguments :
2624 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2625 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2626 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2627 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2628
2629 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2630 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2631 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2632 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2633 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2634
2635 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2636 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2637 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2638 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2639 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2640 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2641
2642 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2643 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2644 will be refused.
2645
2646 Example :
2647 defaults http_instances
2648 mode http
2649
2650 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002653monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002654 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002657 Arguments :
2658 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2659 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002660 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2662 backend and its backup.
2663
2664 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2665 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2666 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2667 servers in a list of backends.
2668
2669 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2670 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2671 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2672 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2673 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2674 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2675 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002676 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2677 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678
2679 Example:
2680 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2683 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2684 monitor-uri /site_alive
2685 monitor fail if site_dead
2686
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002687 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002688
2689
2690monitor-net <source>
2691 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 yes | yes | yes | no
2694 Arguments :
2695 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2696 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2697 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2698 followed by a mask.
2699
2700 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2701 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002703 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2704
2705 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2706 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2707 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2708 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2709 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2710
2711 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2712 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2713 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2714 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2715 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2716
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002717 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2718 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2719
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720 Example :
2721 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2722 frontend www
2723 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2724
2725 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2726
2727
2728monitor-uri <uri>
2729 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2731 yes | yes | yes | no
2732 Arguments :
2733 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2734 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2735
2736 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2737 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2738 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2739 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2740 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2741 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2742 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2743 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2744
2745 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2746 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2747 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2748 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2749 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2750 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2751
2752 Example :
2753 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2754 frontend www
2755 mode http
2756 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2757
2758 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002761option abortonclose
2762no option abortonclose
2763 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 yes | no | yes | yes
2766 Arguments : none
2767
2768 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2769 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2770 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2771 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002772 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002773 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2774 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2775 encountered while delivering the response.
2776
2777 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2778 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2779 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2780 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2781 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2782 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002783 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002784 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002785 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002786 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2787 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2788 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2789
2790 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2791 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2792 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2793 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2794 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2795 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2796 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2797 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002798 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002799
2800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2802
2803 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2804
2805
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002806option accept-invalid-http-request
2807no option accept-invalid-http-request
2808 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments : none
2812
2813 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2814 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2815 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2816 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2817 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2818 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2819 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2820 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2821 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2822
2823 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2824 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2825 been confirmed.
2826
2827 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2828 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2829 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2830 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2831
2832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2834
2835 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2836 stats socket.
2837
2838
2839option accept-invalid-http-response
2840no option accept-invalid-http-response
2841 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2843 yes | no | yes | yes
2844 Arguments : none
2845
2846 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2847 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2848 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2849 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2850 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2851 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2852 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2853 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2854 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2855
2856 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2857 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2858 been confirmed.
2859
2860 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2861 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2862 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2863 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2864
2865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2867
2868 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2869 stats socket.
2870
2871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002872option allbackups
2873no option allbackups
2874 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2876 yes | no | yes | yes
2877 Arguments : none
2878
2879 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2880 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2881 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2882 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2883 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2884 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2885 order between the backup servers anymore.
2886
2887 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2888 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2889
2890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2892
2893
2894option checkcache
2895no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002896 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 yes | no | yes | yes
2899 Arguments : none
2900
2901 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2902 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002903 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002904 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2905 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2906 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2907
2908 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002909 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002910 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002911 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2912 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002913 to the client are :
2914 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002915 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002916 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002917 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2918 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2919 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2920 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2921 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2922 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2923 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2924 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2925 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2926 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2927 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2928
2929 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002930 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002931 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002932 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002933 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2934
2935 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2936 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002937 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002938 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2939
2940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2942
2943
2944option clitcpka
2945no option clitcpka
2946 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2948 yes | yes | yes | no
2949 Arguments : none
2950
2951 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2952 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2953 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2954 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2955
2956 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2957 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2958 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2959 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2960
2961 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2962 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2963 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2964 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2965 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2966
2967 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2968
2969 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2970 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2971 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2972
2973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2975
2976 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2977
2978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979option contstats
2980 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2982 yes | yes | yes | no
2983 Arguments : none
2984
2985 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2986 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2987 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2988 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2989 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2990 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2991 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2992
2993
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002994option dontlog-normal
2995no option dontlog-normal
2996 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2998 yes | yes | yes | no
2999 Arguments : none
3000
3001 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3002 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3003 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3004 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3005 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3006 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3007 logged.
3008
3009 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3010 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3011 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003013 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003014 logging.
3015
3016
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003017option dontlognull
3018no option dontlognull
3019 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 yes | yes | yes | no
3022 Arguments : none
3023
3024 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3025 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3026 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3027 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3028 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3029 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3030 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3031
3032 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3033 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3034 would not be logged.
3035
3036 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3037 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003039 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003040
3041
3042option forceclose
3043no option forceclose
3044 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003046 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003047 Arguments : none
3048
3049 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3050 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3051 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3052 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3053 global session times in the logs.
3054
3055 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003056 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003057 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3058 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3059 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3060 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003061
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003062 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3063 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3064 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3065
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3068
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003069 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003070
3071
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003072option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003073 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3078 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003079 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003080 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003081
3082 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3083 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3084 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3085 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3086 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3087 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3088 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003089 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3090 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3091 possible that the client has already brought one.
3092
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003093 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003094 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003095 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3096 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003097 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3098 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003099
3100 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3101 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3102 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3103 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3104 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3105 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3106 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3107
3108 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003109 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3110 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3111 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003112
3113 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3114 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3115 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3116 when using this option.
3117
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003118 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003119 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3120 frontend www
3121 mode http
3122 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3123
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003124 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3125 backend www
3126 mode http
3127 option forwardfor header X-Client
3128
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003129 See also : "option httpclose"
3130
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003131
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003132option http-no-delay
3133no option http-no-delay
3134 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 yes | yes | yes | yes
3137 Arguments : none
3138
3139 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3140 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3141 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3142 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3143 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3144 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3145 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3146 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3147 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3148 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3149 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3150 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3151 affected.
3152
3153 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3154 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3155 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3156 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3157 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3158 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3159 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3160 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3161 latency environments.
3162
3163
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003164option http-pretend-keepalive
3165no option http-pretend-keepalive
3166 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3168 yes | yes | yes | yes
3169 Arguments : none
3170
3171 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3172 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3173 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3174 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3175 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3176 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3177 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3178 consider the response complete.
3179
3180 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3181 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3182 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3183 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3184 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3185 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3186
3187 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3188 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3189 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3190 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3191 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3192 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3193 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3194
3195 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3196 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003197 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3198 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3199 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003200
3201 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3202 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3203
3204 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3205
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003206
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003207option http-server-close
3208no option http-server-close
3209 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 yes | yes | yes | yes
3212 Arguments : none
3213
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003214 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3215 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3216 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3217 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3218 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3219 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3220 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3221 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3222 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3223 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3224 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3225 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003226
3227 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3228 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3229 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3230 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003231 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3232 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003233
3234 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3235 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003236 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3237 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3238 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003239
3240 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3241 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3242
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003243 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3244 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003245
3246
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003247option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003248no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003249 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3251 yes | yes | yes | no
3252 Arguments : none
3253
3254 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3255 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3256 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3257 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3258 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3259 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3260 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3261
3262 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3263 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3264 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3265 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3266 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3267 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3268 request along its whole life.
3269
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003270 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3271 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3272 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3273 front of an existing proxy.
3274
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003275 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3276
3277 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3278 http-server-close".
3279
3280
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003281option httpchk
3282option httpchk <uri>
3283option httpchk <method> <uri>
3284option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3285 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 yes | no | yes | yes
3288 Arguments :
3289 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3290 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3291 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3292 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3293 ones.
3294
3295 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3296 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3297 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3298
3299 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3300 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3301 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3302 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3303 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3304
3305 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3306 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3307 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3308 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3309 the lack of any response.
3310
3311 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3312
3313 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3314 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3315 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3316
3317 Examples :
3318 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3319 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3320 backend https_relay
3321 mode tcp
3322 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3323 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3324
3325 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003326 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3327 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003328
3329
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003330option httpclose
3331no option httpclose
3332 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 yes | yes | yes | yes
3335 Arguments : none
3336
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003337 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3338 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3339 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3340 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3341 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3342 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3343 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003344
3345 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003346 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3347 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3348 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3349 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3350 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3351 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003352
3353 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3354 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3355 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003356 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3357 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003358
3359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3361
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003362 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3363 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003364
3365
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003366option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003367 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003370 Arguments :
3371 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3372 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3373 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3374 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3375 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003376
3377 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3378 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3379 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3380 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3381 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3382 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3383 ports.
3384
3385 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3386
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3389 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3390 by default.
3391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003392 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003394
3395option http_proxy
3396no option http_proxy
3397 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
3400 Arguments : none
3401
3402 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3403 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3404 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3405 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3406 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3407
3408 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3409 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3410 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3411 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003412 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003413 be analyzed.
3414
3415 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3416 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3417
3418 Example :
3419 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3420 backend direct_forward
3421 option httpclose
3422 option http_proxy
3423
3424 See also : "option httpclose"
3425
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003426
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003427option independant-streams
3428no option independant-streams
3429 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3431 yes | yes | yes | yes
3432 Arguments : none
3433
3434 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3435 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3436 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3437 receive data or not.
3438
3439 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3440 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3441 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3442 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3443 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3444 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3445 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3446 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3447 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3448 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3449 socket buffers.
3450
3451 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3452 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3453 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3454 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3455 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3456
3457 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3458
3459
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003460option ldap-check
3461 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | no | yes | yes
3464 Arguments : none
3465
3466 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3467 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3468 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3469 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3470
3471 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3472 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3473
3474 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3475 configure it.
3476
3477 Example :
3478 option ldap-check
3479
3480 See also : "option httpchk"
3481
3482
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003483option log-health-checks
3484no option log-health-checks
3485 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | no | yes | yes
3488 Arguments : none
3489
3490 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3491 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3492 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3493 of additional information is limited.
3494
3495 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3496 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3497
3498 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3499
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003500
3501option log-separate-errors
3502no option log-separate-errors
3503 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments : none
3507
3508 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3509 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3510 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3511 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3512 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3513 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3514 provides very important information.
3515
3516 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3517 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3518 error logs.
3519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003520 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003521 logging.
3522
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003523
3524option logasap
3525no option logasap
3526 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 yes | yes | yes | no
3529 Arguments : none
3530
3531 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3532 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3533 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3534 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3535 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3536 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3537 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003538 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003539 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3540 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003542 Examples :
3543 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3544 mode http
3545 option httplog
3546 option logasap
3547 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3548
3549 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3550 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3551 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3552 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003554 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003555 logging.
3556
3557
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003558option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3559 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003562 Arguments :
3563 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3564 to MySQL server.
3565
3566 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3567 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3568 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3569 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3570 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3571 in the MySQL table, like this :
3572
3573 USE mysql;
3574 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3575 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3576
3577 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3578 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3579 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3580 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3581 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3582 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3583 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3584 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3585 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3586
3587 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3588 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003589
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003590 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003591
3592 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3593 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3594 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3595 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3596 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3597 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3598
3599 See also: "option httpchk"
3600
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003601option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3602 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | no | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3607 to PostgreSQL server.
3608
3609 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3610 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3611 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3612 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3613
3614 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003615
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003616option nolinger
3617no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003618 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003621 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003622
3623 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3624 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3625 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3626 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3627 connections.
3628
3629 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3630 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3631 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3632 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3633 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3634 this too.
3635
3636 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3637 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3638 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3639
3640 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3641 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3642 for servers.
3643
3644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3646
3647
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003648option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3649 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3651 yes | yes | yes | yes
3652 Arguments :
3653 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3654 matching <network>
3655 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3656 header name.
3657
3658 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3659 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3660 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3661 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3662 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3663 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3664 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3665 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3666 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3667 possible that the client has already brought one.
3668
3669 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3670 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3671 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3672 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3673 header and requires different one.
3674
3675 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3676 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3677 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3678 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3679 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3680 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3681 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3682
3683 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3684 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3685 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3686 both are defined.
3687
3688 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3689 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3690 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3691 when using this option.
3692
3693 Examples :
3694 # Original Destination address
3695 frontend www
3696 mode http
3697 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3698
3699 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3700 backend www
3701 mode http
3702 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3703
3704 See also : "option httpclose"
3705
3706
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003707option persist
3708no option persist
3709 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003712 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003713
3714 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3715 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3716 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3717 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3718 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3719 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3720 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3721 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3722 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3723 redirected to another valid server.
3724
3725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3727
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003728 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003729
3730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003731option redispatch
3732no option redispatch
3733 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003736 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003737
3738 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3739 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3740 be able to access the service anymore.
3741
3742 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3743 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3744
3745 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3746 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3747 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003749 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3750 "redisp" keywords.
3751
3752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003755 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003757
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003758option redis-check
3759 Use redis health checks for server testing
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 yes | no | yes | yes
3762 Arguments : none
3763
3764 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3765 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3766 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3767 find the "+PONG" response message.
3768
3769 Example :
3770 option redis-check
3771
3772 See also : "option httpchk"
3773
3774
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003775option smtpchk
3776option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3777 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003780 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003781 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3782 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3783 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3784
3785 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3786 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3787 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3788
3789 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3790 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3791 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3792 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3793 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3794 dead server.
3795
3796 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3797 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3798 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3799 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3800
3801 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3802 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3803 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3804 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3805 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3806
3807 Example :
3808 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3809
3810 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003813option socket-stats
3814no option socket-stats
3815
3816 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3818 yes | yes | yes | no
3819
3820 Arguments : none
3821
3822
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003823option splice-auto
3824no option splice-auto
3825 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828 Arguments : none
3829
3830 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3831 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3832 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3833 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003834 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003835 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3836 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3837 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3838 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3839
3840 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3841 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3842 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3843 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3844 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3845 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3846 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3847 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3848 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3849 keyword.
3850
3851 Example :
3852 option splice-auto
3853
3854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3856
3857 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3858 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3859
3860
3861option splice-request
3862no option splice-request
3863 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | yes | yes | yes
3866 Arguments : none
3867
3868 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3869 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3870 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3871 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3872 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3873 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3874
3875 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3876
3877 Example :
3878 option splice-request
3879
3880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3882
3883 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3884 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3885
3886
3887option splice-response
3888no option splice-response
3889 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | yes | yes | yes
3892 Arguments : none
3893
3894 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3895 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3896 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3897 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3898 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3899 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3900
3901 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3902
3903 Example :
3904 option splice-response
3905
3906 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3907 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3908
3909 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3910 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3911
3912
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003913option srvtcpka
3914no option srvtcpka
3915 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | no | yes | yes
3918 Arguments : none
3919
3920 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3921 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3922 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3923 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3924
3925 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3926 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3927 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3928 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3929
3930 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3931 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3932 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3933 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3934 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3935
3936 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3937
3938 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3939 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3940 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3941
3942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3944
3945 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3946
3947
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003948option ssl-hello-chk
3949 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3951 yes | no | yes | yes
3952 Arguments : none
3953
3954 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3955 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3956 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3957 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3958 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3959 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3960 hello message.
3961
3962 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3963 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3964 messages, which is appreciable.
3965
3966 See also: "option httpchk"
3967
3968
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003969option tcp-smart-accept
3970no option tcp-smart-accept
3971 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3973 yes | yes | yes | no
3974 Arguments : none
3975
3976 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3977 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3978 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3979 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3980 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3981 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3982
3983 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3984 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3985 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3986 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3987
3988 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3989 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3990 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3991 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3992
3993 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3994 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3995 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3996
3997 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3998 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3999 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4000
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004001 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4002
4003
4004option tcp-smart-connect
4005no option tcp-smart-connect
4006 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | no | yes | yes
4009 Arguments : none
4010
4011 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4012 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4013 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4014 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4015 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4016
4017 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4018 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4019 complex.
4020
4021 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4022 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4023 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4024
4025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4027
4028 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4029
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004030
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004031option tcpka
4032 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4038 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4039 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4040 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4041
4042 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4043 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4044 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4045 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4046
4047 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4048 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4049 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4050 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4051 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4052
4053 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4054
4055 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4056 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4057 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4058 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4059 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4060 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4061 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4062 backends.
4063
4064 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4065
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004066
4067option tcplog
4068 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 yes | yes | yes | yes
4071 Arguments : none
4072
4073 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4074 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4075 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4076 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4077 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4078 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4079 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4080 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4081
4082 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004084 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004085
4086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004087option transparent
4088no option transparent
4089 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004091 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004092 Arguments : none
4093
4094 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4095 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4096 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4097 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4098 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4099 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4100 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4101 appropriate server.
4102
4103 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4104 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4105
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004106 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004107 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004108
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004109
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004110persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004111persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004112 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4114 yes | no | yes | yes
4115 Arguments :
4116 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004117 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4118 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004119
4120 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4121 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4122 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4123 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4124 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4125 forwarded to this server.
4126
4127 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4128 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4129 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004130 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004131 a single "listen" section.
4132
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004133 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4134 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4135 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4136
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004137 Example :
4138 listen tse-farm
4139 bind :3389
4140 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4141 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4142 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4143 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4144 persist rdp-cookie
4145 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4146 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4147 balance rdp-cookie
4148 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4149 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4150
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004151 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4152 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004153
4154
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004155rate-limit sessions <rate>
4156 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | yes | yes | no
4159 Arguments :
4160 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4161 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4162
4163 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4164 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4165 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4166 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4167 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4168 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4169
4170 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4171 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4172 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4173 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4174
4175 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4176 listen smtp
4177 mode tcp
4178 bind :25
4179 rate-limit sessions 10
4180 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4181
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004182 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4183 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4184 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004185
4186 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4187
4188
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004189redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4190redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004191 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 no | yes | yes | yes
4194
4195 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004196 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004197
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004198 Arguments :
4199 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4200 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4201 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4202 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004203 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4204 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4205 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4206 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004207
4208 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4209 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4210 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4211 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4212 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4213 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4214 location with a GET method.
4215
4216 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4217 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4218
4219 - "drop-query"
4220 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4221 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4222 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4223 with a location-type redirect.
4224
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004225 - "append-slash"
4226 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4227 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4228 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4229 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4230
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004231 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4232 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4233 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4234 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4235 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4236 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4237 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4238
4239 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4240 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4241 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4242 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4243 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4244 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4245 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004246
4247 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4248 acl clear dst_port 80
4249 acl secure dst_port 8080
4250 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004251 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004252 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004253 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4254
4255 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004256 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4257 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4258 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004259 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004260
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004261 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4262 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4263 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004265 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004266
4267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004268redisp (deprecated)
4269redispatch (deprecated)
4270 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004273 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004274
4275 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4276 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4277 be able to access the service anymore.
4278
4279 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4280 redistribute them to a working server.
4281
4282 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4283 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4284 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004286 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4287 "option redispatch" instead.
4288
4289 See also : "option redispatch"
4290
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004291
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004292reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004293 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4295 no | yes | yes | yes
4296 Arguments :
4297 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4298 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004299 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004300
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004301 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4302 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4303
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004304 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4305 the last header of an HTTP request.
4306
4307 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4308 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4309 responses.
4310
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004311 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4312 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4313 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4314
4315 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4316 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004317
4318
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004319reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4320reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004321 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 no | yes | yes | yes
4324 Arguments :
4325 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4326 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4327 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4328 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4329 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4330 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4331 ignores case.
4332
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004333 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4334 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4335
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004336 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4337 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4338 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4339 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004340 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004341
4342 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4343 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4344
4345 Example :
4346 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4347 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4348 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4349
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004350 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4351 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004352
4353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004354reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4355reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004356 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 no | yes | yes | yes
4359 Arguments :
4360 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4361 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4362 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4363 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4364 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4365 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4371 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4372 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4373 next servers.
4374
4375 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4376 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4377 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4378
4379 Example :
4380 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4381 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4382 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4383
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004384 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4385 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004386
4387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004388reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4389reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004390 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 no | yes | yes | yes
4393 Arguments :
4394 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4395 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4396 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4397 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4398 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4399 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4400 case.
4401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004402 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4403 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4404
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004405 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4406 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4407 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4408 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004409 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004410
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004411 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004412 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004413 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004414
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004415 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4416 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4417
4418 Example :
4419 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4420 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4421 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004423 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4424 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004425
4426
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004427reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4428reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004429 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 no | yes | yes | yes
4432 Arguments :
4433 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4434 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4435 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4436 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4437 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4438 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4439 case.
4440
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004441 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4442 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4443
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004444 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4445 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4446 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4447 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4448
4449 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4450 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4451
4452 Example :
4453 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4454 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4455 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4456 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004458 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4459 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460
4461
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004462reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4463reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004464 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 no | yes | yes | yes
4467 Arguments :
4468 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4469 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4470 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4471 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4472 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4473 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4474
4475 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4476 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4477 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4478 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004479 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004481 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4482 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4483
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004484 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4485 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4486 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4487
4488 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4489 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4490 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4491 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4492 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4493
4494 Example :
4495 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4496 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4497 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4498 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004500 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4501 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004502
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4505reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 no | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4511 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4512 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4513 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4514 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4515 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4516 ignores case.
4517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004518 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4519 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4520
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004521 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4522 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004523 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4524 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4525 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004526 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4527 not set.
4528
4529 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4530 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4531 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4532 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4533 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4534
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004535 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004536 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4537 # block all others.
4538 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4539 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004541 # block bad guys
4542 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4543 reqitarpit . if badguys
4544
4545 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4546 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547
4548
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004549retries <value>
4550 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | no | yes | yes
4553 Arguments :
4554 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4555 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4556 default value is 3.
4557
4558 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4559 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4560 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4561
4562 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4563 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4564
4565 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4566 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4567
4568 See also : "option redispatch"
4569
4570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004571rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004572 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 no | yes | yes | yes
4575 Arguments :
4576 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4577 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004578 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004579
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004580 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4581 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4582
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4584 the last header of an HTTP response.
4585
4586 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4587 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4588 responses.
4589
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004590 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4591 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004592
4593
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004594rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4595rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004596 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 no | yes | yes | yes
4599 Arguments :
4600 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4601 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4602 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4603 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4604 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4605 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4606 ignores case.
4607
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004611 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4612 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4613 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4614 client.
4615
4616 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4617 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4618 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4619
4620 Example :
4621 # remove the Server header from responses
4622 reqidel ^Server:.*
4623
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004624 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4625 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004626
4627
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004628rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4629rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004630 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 no | yes | yes | yes
4633 Arguments :
4634 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4635 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4636 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4637 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4638 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4639 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4640 ignores case.
4641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004642 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4643 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4644
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004645 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4646 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4647 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4648 case-sensitive.
4649
4650 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004651 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4652 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4653 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004654
4655 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4656 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4657
4658 Example :
4659 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4660 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004662 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4663 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004664
4665
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004666rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4667rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | yes
4671 Arguments :
4672 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4673 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4674 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4675 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4676 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4677 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4678 ignores case.
4679
4680 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4681 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4682 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4683 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004684 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004686 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4687 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4688
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004689 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4690 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4691 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4692
4693 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4694 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4695 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4696 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4697 are not case-sensitive.
4698
4699 Example :
4700 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4701 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4702
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004703 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4704 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004705
4706
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004707server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004708 Declare a server in a backend
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 no | no | yes | yes
4711 Arguments :
4712 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4713 appear in logs and alerts.
4714
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004715 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4716 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4717 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4718 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004719 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4720 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4721 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4722 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4723 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4724 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004725
4726 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4727 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4728 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4729 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4730 adding this value to the client's port.
4731
4732 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4733 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004734 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004735
4736 Examples :
4737 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4738 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004740 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004741
4742
4743source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004744source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004745source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004746 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | no | yes | yes
4749 Arguments :
4750 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4751 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4752 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4753 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4754
4755 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4756 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004757 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4758 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4759 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004760
4761 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4762 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4763 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4764 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4765 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4766 <addr>.
4767
4768 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4769 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4770 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4771 port.
4772
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004773 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4774 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4775 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4776 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4777 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4778 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4779 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4780 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4781 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4782 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4783 HTTP header.
4784
4785 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4786 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4787 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4788 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4789 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4790 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4791 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4792 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4793 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4794 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4795
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004796 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4797 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4798 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4799 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4800 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4801 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004803 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4804 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4805 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4806 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4807
4808 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4809 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4810 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4811 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4812 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4813 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4814
4815 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4816 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4817 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4818 there are two methods :
4819
4820 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4821 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4822 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4823 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4824 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4825 of the client ranges may be used.
4826
4827 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4828 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4829 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4830 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4831 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4832 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4833 same session.
4834
4835 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4836 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4837 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4838 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4839 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4840 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4841
4842 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4843 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4844 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004845 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004846
4847 Examples :
4848 backend private
4849 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4850 source 192.168.1.200
4851
4852 backend transparent_ssl1
4853 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4854 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4855
4856 backend transparent_ssl2
4857 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4858 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4859 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4860
4861 backend transparent_ssl3
4862 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4863 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4864 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4865
4866 backend transparent_smtp
4867 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4868 # with Tproxy version 4.
4869 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4870
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004871 backend transparent_http
4872 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4873 # proxy.
4874 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004876 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004877 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004879
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004880srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4881 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | no | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4887 as explained at the top of this document.
4888
4889 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4890 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4891 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4892 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4893 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4894 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4895 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4896
4897 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4898 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4899 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4900 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4901 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004902 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004903 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004904 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004905
4906 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4907 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4908 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4909 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4910 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4911 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4912
4913 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4914 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4915
4916 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4917
4918
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004919stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4920 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 no | no | yes | yes
4923
4924 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4925 matched.
4926
4927 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4928 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4929
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004930 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4931 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4932 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4933
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004934 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4935 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4936 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4937 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004938
4939 Example :
4940 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4941 backend stats_localhost
4942 stats enable
4943 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4944
4945 Example :
4946 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4947 backend stats_auth
4948 stats enable
4949 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4950 stats admin if TRUE
4951
4952 Example :
4953 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4954 userlist stats-auth
4955 group admin users admin
4956 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4957 group readonly users haproxy
4958 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4959
4960 backend stats_auth
4961 stats enable
4962 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4963 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4964 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4965 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4966
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004967 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4968 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4969 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004970
4971
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004972stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4973 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4975 yes | no | yes | yes
4976 Arguments :
4977 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4978
4979 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4980
4981 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4982 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4983 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4984 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4985 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4986 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4987
4988 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4989 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4990 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4991 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4992
4993 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4994 report using "stats scope".
4995
4996 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4997 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4998 unobvious parameters.
4999
5000 Example :
5001 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5002 backend public_www
5003 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5004 stats enable
5005 stats hide-version
5006 stats scope .
5007 stats uri /admin?stats
5008 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5009 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5010 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5011
5012 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5013 backend private_monitoring
5014 stats enable
5015 stats uri /admin?stats
5016 stats refresh 5s
5017
5018 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5019
5020
5021stats enable
5022 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025 Arguments : none
5026
5027 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5028 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5029 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5030 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5031 - stats auth : no authentication
5032 - stats scope : no restriction
5033
5034 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5035 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5036 unobvious parameters.
5037
5038 Example :
5039 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5040 backend public_www
5041 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5042 stats enable
5043 stats hide-version
5044 stats scope .
5045 stats uri /admin?stats
5046 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5047 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5048 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5049
5050 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5051 backend private_monitoring
5052 stats enable
5053 stats uri /admin?stats
5054 stats refresh 5s
5055
5056 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5057
5058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005059stats hide-version
5060 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005063 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005064
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005065 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5066 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5067 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5068 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5069 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5070 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005072 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5073 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5074 unobvious parameters.
5075
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005076 Example :
5077 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5078 backend public_www
5079 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005080 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005081 stats hide-version
5082 stats scope .
5083 stats uri /admin?stats
5084 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5085 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5086 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005087
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005088 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5089 backend private_monitoring
5090 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005091 stats uri /admin?stats
5092 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005093
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005094 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005095
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005096
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005097stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5098 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5099 Access control for statistics
5100
5101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 no | no | yes | yes
5103
5104 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5105 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5106 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5107 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5108 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5109 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5110
5111 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5112 instance.
5113
5114 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5115 about ACL usage.
5116
5117
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005118stats realm <realm>
5119 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 yes | no | yes | yes
5122 Arguments :
5123 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5124 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5125 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5126
5127 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5128 using a backslash ('\').
5129
5130 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5131 only related to authentication.
5132
5133 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5134 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5135 unobvious parameters.
5136
5137 Example :
5138 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5139 backend public_www
5140 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5141 stats enable
5142 stats hide-version
5143 stats scope .
5144 stats uri /admin?stats
5145 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5146 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5147 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5148
5149 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5150 backend private_monitoring
5151 stats enable
5152 stats uri /admin?stats
5153 stats refresh 5s
5154
5155 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5156
5157
5158stats refresh <delay>
5159 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | no | yes | yes
5162 Arguments :
5163 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5164 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5165 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5166 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5167 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5168 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5169
5170 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5171 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5172 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5173 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5174
5175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5177 unobvious parameters.
5178
5179 Example :
5180 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5181 backend public_www
5182 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5183 stats enable
5184 stats hide-version
5185 stats scope .
5186 stats uri /admin?stats
5187 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5188 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5189 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5190
5191 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5192 backend private_monitoring
5193 stats enable
5194 stats uri /admin?stats
5195 stats refresh 5s
5196
5197 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5198
5199
5200stats scope { <name> | "." }
5201 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | no | yes | yes
5204 Arguments :
5205 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5206 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5207 section in which the statement appears.
5208
5209 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5210 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5211 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5212 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5213 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5214 exists.
5215
5216 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5217 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5218 unobvious parameters.
5219
5220 Example :
5221 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5222 backend public_www
5223 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5224 stats enable
5225 stats hide-version
5226 stats scope .
5227 stats uri /admin?stats
5228 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5229 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5230 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5231
5232 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5233 backend private_monitoring
5234 stats enable
5235 stats uri /admin?stats
5236 stats refresh 5s
5237
5238 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5239
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005240
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005241stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005242 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | no | yes | yes
5245
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005246 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005247 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5248
5249 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5250 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5251
5252 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5253 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5254 unobvious parameters.
5255
5256 Example :
5257 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5258 backend private_monitoring
5259 stats enable
5260 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5261 stats uri /admin?stats
5262 stats refresh 5s
5263
5264 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5265 global section.
5266
5267
5268stats show-legends
5269 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5270 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5271 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5272 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5273 - IP (socket, server)
5274 - cookie (backend, server)
5275
5276 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5277 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5278 unobvious parameters.
5279
5280 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5281
5282
5283stats show-node [ <name> ]
5284 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | no | yes | yes
5287 Arguments:
5288 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5289 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5290
5291 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5292 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5293 provided for each customer.
5294
5295 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5296 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5297 unobvious parameters.
5298
5299 Example:
5300 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5301 backend private_monitoring
5302 stats enable
5303 stats show-node Europe-1
5304 stats uri /admin?stats
5305 stats refresh 5s
5306
5307 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5308 section.
5309
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005310
5311stats uri <prefix>
5312 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5314 yes | no | yes | yes
5315 Arguments :
5316 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5317 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5318 query string.
5319
5320 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5321 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5322 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5323 possible to reach it in the application.
5324
5325 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005326 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005327 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5328 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5329 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5330 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5331
5332 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5333 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5334 an address or a port to statistics only.
5335
5336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5338 unobvious parameters.
5339
5340 Example :
5341 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5342 backend public_www
5343 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5344 stats enable
5345 stats hide-version
5346 stats scope .
5347 stats uri /admin?stats
5348 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5349 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5350 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5351
5352 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5353 backend private_monitoring
5354 stats enable
5355 stats uri /admin?stats
5356 stats refresh 5s
5357
5358 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5359
5360
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005361stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5362 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005364 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005365
5366 Arguments :
5367 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5368 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5369 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5370 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5371
5372 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5373 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5374 the "stick-table" statement.
5375
5376 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5377 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5378 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5379 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5380 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5381
5382 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5383 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5384 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5385 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5386 transformation rules.
5387
5388 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5389 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5390 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5391 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5392 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5393 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5394 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5395
5396 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5397 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5398 ACL based conditions.
5399
5400 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5401 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5402 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5403 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5404
5405 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5406 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5407 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5408 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5409
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005410 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5411 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5412 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5413
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005414 Example :
5415 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5416 # last 30 minutes
5417 backend pop
5418 mode tcp
5419 balance roundrobin
5420 stick store-request src
5421 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5422 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5423 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5424
5425 backend smtp
5426 mode tcp
5427 balance roundrobin
5428 stick match src table pop
5429 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5430 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5431
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005432 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5433 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005434
5435
5436stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5437 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5439 no | no | yes | yes
5440
5441 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5442 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5443 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5444 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5445
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005446 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5447 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5448 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5449
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005450 Examples :
5451 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005452 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005453
5454 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5455 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5456 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5457
5458
5459 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5460 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5461 backend http
5462 mode http
5463 balance roundrobin
5464 stick on src table https
5465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5466 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5467 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5468
5469 backend https
5470 mode tcp
5471 balance roundrobin
5472 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5473 stick on src
5474 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5475 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005477 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005478
5479
5480stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5481 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5483 no | no | yes | yes
5484
5485 Arguments :
5486 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5487 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5488 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5489 server is selected.
5490
5491 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5492 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5493 the "stick-table" statement.
5494
5495 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5496 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5497 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5498 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5499 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5500 address.
5501
5502 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5503 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5504 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5505 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5506 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5507 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5508 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5509 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5510 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5511 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5512
5513 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5514 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5515 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5516 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5517 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5518 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5519 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5520
5521 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5522 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5523 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5524 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5525
5526 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5527 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5528 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5529 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5530 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5531 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5532 another protocol or access method.
5533
5534 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5535 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5536 the request.
5537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5541
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005542 Example :
5543 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5544 # last 30 minutes
5545 backend pop
5546 mode tcp
5547 balance roundrobin
5548 stick store-request src
5549 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5550 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5551 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5552
5553 backend smtp
5554 mode tcp
5555 balance roundrobin
5556 stick match src table pop
5557 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5558 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5559
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005560 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5561 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005562
5563
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005564stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005565 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5566 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005567 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005569 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005570
5571 Arguments :
5572 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5573 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5574 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5575 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5576
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005577 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5578 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5579 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5580 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5581
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005582 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5583 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5584 instance.
5585
5586 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5587 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5588 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5589 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5590 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5591 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005592 to 32 characters.
5593
5594 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5595 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5596 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5597 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5598 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5599 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005600
5601 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005602 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5603 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005604 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5605 increase.
5606
5607 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005608 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5609 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5610 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005611
5612 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5613 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5614 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5615 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5616 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5617 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5618 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5619 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5620 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5621 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5622 parameter (see below).
5623
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005624 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5625 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5626 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5627 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5628 soft restart.
5629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005630 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5631
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005632 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5633 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5634 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5635 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5636 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5637 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5638 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5639 if not expiration delay is specified.
5640
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005641 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5642 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5643 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5644 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005645 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5646 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5647 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5648 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5649 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5650 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5651 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5652 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5653 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5654 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5655 types and their arguments.
5656
5657 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5658 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5659 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5660 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5661
5662 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5663 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5664 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5665 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5666
5667 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5668 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5669 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5670 they were received.
5671
5672 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5673 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5674 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5675 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5676 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5677
5678 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5679 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5680 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5681 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5682 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5683
5684 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5685 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5686 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5687
5688 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5689 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5690 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5691 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5692 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5693
5694 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5695 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5696 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5697 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5698 the client side.
5699
5700 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5701 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5702 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5703 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5704 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5705 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5706 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5707
5708 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5709 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5710 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5711 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5712 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5713 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5714 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5715
5716 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5717 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5718 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5719 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5720 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5721 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5722
5723 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5724 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5725 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5726 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5727
5728 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5729 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5730 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5731 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5732 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5733 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5734 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5735 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5736 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5737 recommended for better fairness.
5738
5739 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5740 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5741 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5742 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5743
5744 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5745 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5746 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5747 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5748 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5749 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5750 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5751 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5752 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5753 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005754
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005755 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5756 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005757 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5758 reference it.
5759
5760 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5761 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5762 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5763 as an exclusive stickiness.
5764
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005765 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5766 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5767 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5768 something that can be ignored.
5769
5770 Example:
5771 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5772 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5773 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5774 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5775
5776 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005777 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005778
5779
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005780stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5781 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 no | no | yes | yes
5784
5785 Arguments :
5786 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5787 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5788 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5789 server is selected.
5790
5791 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5792 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5793 the "stick-table" statement.
5794
5795 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5796 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5797 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5798 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5799
5800 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5801 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5802 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5803 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5804 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5805 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5806 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5807 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5808 rules.
5809
5810 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5811 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5812 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5813 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5814 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5815 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5816 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5817
5818 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5819 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5820 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5821 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5822
5823 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5824 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5825 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5826 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5827 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5828 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5829 another protocol or access method.
5830
5831 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5832
5833 Example :
5834 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5835 backend https
5836 mode tcp
5837 balance roundrobin
5838 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5839 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5840
5841 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5842 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5843
5844 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5845 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5846 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5847
5848 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5849 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5850
5851 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5852 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5853 # at offset 44.
5854
5855 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5856 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5857
5858 # Learn on response if server hello.
5859 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5860
5861 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5862 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5863
5864 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5865 extraction.
5866
5867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005868tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5869 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5871 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005872 Arguments :
5873 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5874 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5875 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005876
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005877 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005878
5879 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5880 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005881 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5882 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5883 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5884 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5885 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5886 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005888 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5889 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5890 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5891 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005893 Three types of actions are supported :
5894 - accept :
5895 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5896 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5897 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005899 - reject :
5900 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5901 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5902 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5903 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5904 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5905 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5906 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5907 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5908 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5909 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5910 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5911 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5914 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5915 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5916 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5917 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5918 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5919 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5920 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5921 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005923 These actions take one or two arguments :
5924 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5925 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5926 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005927
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005928 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5929 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5930 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5931 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005933 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5934 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5935 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5936 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5937 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5938 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5939 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5940 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5941 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5942 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005944 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5945 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5946 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005948 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5949 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5950 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005952 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005953 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005954 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005956 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5957 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5958 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5961 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5962 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005963
5964 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005966 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005967
5968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005969tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5970 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005972 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 Arguments :
5974 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5975 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5976 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5981 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5982 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5983 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5984 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5987 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5988 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5989 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5990 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5991 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5992 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5993 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5994 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005996 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5997 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5998 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5999 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006001 Three types of actions are supported :
6002 - accept :
6003 - reject :
6004 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006006 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6007 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006009 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6010 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6011 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6012 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6013 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6014 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006016 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006017 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6018 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006020 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6021 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6022 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6023 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6024 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006025
6026 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006027 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6028 # and reject everything else.
6029 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6030 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6031 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6032 tcp-request content reject
6033
6034 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006035 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6036 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6037 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006038 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006039
6040 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6041 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6042 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006044 tcp-request content reject
6045
6046 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6047 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6048
6049 frontend http
6050 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6051 # protecting all our sites
6052 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6053 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6054 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6055 ...
6056 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6057
6058 backend http_dynamic
6059 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6060 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6061 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6062 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6063 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6064 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6065 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006067 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006069 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006070
6071
6072tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6073 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006075 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006076 Arguments :
6077 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6078 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6079 as explained at the top of this document.
6080
6081 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6082 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6083 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6084 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6085 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6086
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006087 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6088 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6089 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6090 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6091
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006092 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6093 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006094 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006095 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006096 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6097 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6098 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6099 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006100
6101 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6102 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6103 it pass through unaffected.
6104
6105 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6106 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6107 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006108 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006109 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6110 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006111 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6112 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6113 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006114
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006115 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006116 "timeout client".
6117
6118
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006119tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6120 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 no | no | yes | yes
6123 Arguments :
6124 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6125 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6126 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6127
6128 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6129
6130 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6131 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6132 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6133 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6134 set and expires with no matching rule.
6135
6136 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6137
6138 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6139 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6140 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6141 inserted.
6142
6143 Two types of actions are supported :
6144 - accept :
6145 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6146 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6147 the rules evaluation.
6148
6149 - reject :
6150 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6151 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6152 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6153
6154 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6155 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6156 for changing the default action to a reject.
6157
6158 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6159 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6160 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6161 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6162 period.
6163
6164 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6165
6166 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6167
6168
6169tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6170 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 no | no | yes | yes
6173 Arguments :
6174 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6175 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6176 as explained at the top of this document.
6177
6178 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6179
6180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006181timeout check <timeout>
6182 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6183 established.
6184
6185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
6187 Arguments:
6188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6190 as explained at the top of this document.
6191
6192 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6193 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6194 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6195 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006196 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6197 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6198 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006199
6200 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6201 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6202
6203 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6204 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006205 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006206
6207 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6208 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6209 forget about it.
6210
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006211 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6212 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006213
6214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006215timeout client <timeout>
6216timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6217 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | yes | yes | no
6220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6223 as explained at the top of this document.
6224
6225 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6226 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6227 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6228 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6229 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6230 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6231 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6232 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006233 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006234 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6235 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6236
6237 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6238 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6239 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6240 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6241 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6242 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6243
6244 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6245 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6246 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6247
6248 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6249
6250
6251timeout connect <timeout>
6252timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6253 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6255 yes | no | yes | yes
6256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6259 as explained at the top of this document.
6260
6261 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006262 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006263 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006264 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006265 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6266 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006267
6268 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6269 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6270 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6271 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6272 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6273 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6274
6275 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6276 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6277 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6278
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006279 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6280 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006281
6282
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006283timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6284 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6286 yes | yes | yes | yes
6287 Arguments :
6288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6290 as explained at the top of this document.
6291
6292 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6293 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6294 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6295 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6296 once the request has started to present itself.
6297
6298 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6299 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6300 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6301 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6302 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6303
6304 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6305 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6306 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6307 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6308
6309 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6310 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6311 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6312 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6313 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006314 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006315
6316 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6317 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6318 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6319 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6320
6321 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6322
6323
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006324timeout http-request <timeout>
6325 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006328 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6331 as explained at the top of this document.
6332
6333 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6334 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6335 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6336 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6337 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6338 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6339 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6340 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6341
6342 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6343 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006344 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6345 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006346
6347 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6348 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6349 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6350 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6351 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6352
6353 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006354 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6355 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6356 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006357
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006358 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006359
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006360
6361timeout queue <timeout>
6362 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6364 yes | no | yes | yes
6365 Arguments :
6366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6368 as explained at the top of this document.
6369
6370 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6371 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6372 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6373 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6374 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6375
6376 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6377 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6378 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6379 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6380
6381 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6382
6383
6384timeout server <timeout>
6385timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6386 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6388 yes | no | yes | yes
6389 Arguments :
6390 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6391 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6392 as explained at the top of this document.
6393
6394 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6395 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6396 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6397 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6398 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6399 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6400 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6401
6402 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6403 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6404 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6405 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6406 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006407 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006408 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006409 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006410
6411 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6412 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6413 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6414 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6415 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6416 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6417
6418 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6419 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6420 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6421
6422 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6423
6424
6425timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006426 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6428 yes | yes | yes | yes
6429 Arguments :
6430 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6431 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6432 as explained at the top of this document.
6433
6434 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6435 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6436 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6437
6438 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6439 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6440 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6441 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006442 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006443
6444 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6445
6446
6447transparent (deprecated)
6448 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006450 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006451 Arguments : none
6452
6453 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6454 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6455 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6456 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6457 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6458 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6459 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6460 appropriate server.
6461
6462 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6463
6464 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6465 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6466
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006467 See also: "option transparent"
6468
6469
6470use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6471use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006472 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 no | yes | yes | no
6475 Arguments :
6476 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006478 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006479
6480 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6481 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6482 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006483 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6484 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6485 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6486 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006487
6488 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6489 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6490 assign the backend.
6491
6492 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6493 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6494 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6495 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6496 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6497 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6498
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006499 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006500 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006501 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6502 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6503 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6504
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006505 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006506
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010065085. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006509------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006511The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6512which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6513arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6514settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6515after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6516Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6517address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006519 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006520 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006522The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006524addr <ipv4>
6525 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6526 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6527 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6528 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6529 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006531 Supported in default-server: No
6532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006533backup
6534 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6535 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6536 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6537 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6538 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6539 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006541 Supported in default-server: No
6542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006543check
6544 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6545 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6546 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6547 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6548 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6549 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6550 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6551 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6552 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006553 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6554 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006556 Supported in default-server: No
6557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006558cookie <value>
6559 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6560 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6561 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6562 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6563 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6564 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6565 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006567 Supported in default-server: No
6568
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006569disabled
6570 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6571 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6572 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6573 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6574 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6575
6576 Supported in default-server: No
6577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006578error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006579 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6580 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6581 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006583 Supported in default-server: Yes
6584
6585 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006587fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006588 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6589 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6590 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006592 Supported in default-server: Yes
6593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006594id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006595 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6596 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6597 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006599 Supported in default-server: No
6600
6601inter <delay>
6602fastinter <delay>
6603downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006604 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6605 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6606 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6607 between checks depending on the server state :
6608
6609 Server state | Interval used
6610 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6611 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6612 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6613 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6614 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6615 or yet unchecked. |
6616 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6617 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6618 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006620 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6621 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6622 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6623 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6624 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6625 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6626 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6627 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6628 servers.
6629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006630 Supported in default-server: Yes
6631
6632maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006633 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6634 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6635 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6636 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6637 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6638 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6639 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6640 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006642 Supported in default-server: Yes
6643
6644maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006645 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6646 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6647 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6648 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6649 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6650 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6651 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006653 Supported in default-server: Yes
6654
6655minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006656 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6657 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6658 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6659 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6660 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6661 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006662 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006663 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006665 Supported in default-server: Yes
6666
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006667non-stick
6668 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6669 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6670 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006672observe <mode>
6673 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6674 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6675 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6676 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6677 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6678 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6679 headers, a timeout, etc.
6680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006681 Supported in default-server: No
6682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006683 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006685on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006686 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6687 Currently, four modes are available:
6688 - fastinter: force fastinter
6689 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6690 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6691 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6692 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006694 Supported in default-server: Yes
6695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006696 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6697
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006698on-marked-down <action>
6699 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6700 Currently one action is available:
6701 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6702
6703 Actions are disabled by default
6704
6705 Supported in default-server: Yes
6706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006707port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006708 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6709 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6710 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6711 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6712 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6713 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006715 Supported in default-server: Yes
6716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006717redir <prefix>
6718 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6719 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6720 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6721 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6722 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6723 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6724 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6725 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006726 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006727 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6728 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6729 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6730 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6731 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6732
6733 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006735 Supported in default-server: No
6736
6737rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006738 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6739 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6740 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006742 Supported in default-server: Yes
6743
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006744send-proxy
6745 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6746 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6747 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6748 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6749 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6750 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6751 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6752 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6753 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6754 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6755 option of the "bind" keyword.
6756
6757 Supported in default-server: No
6758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006759slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006760 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6761 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6762 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6763 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6764 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6765 parameters :
6766
6767 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6768 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6769
6770 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6771 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6772 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6773 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6774
6775 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6776 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6777 seen as failed.
6778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006779 Supported in default-server: Yes
6780
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006781source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006782source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006783source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006784 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6785 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6786 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6787 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6788
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006789 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6790 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6791 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6792 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6793 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6794 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6795 server.
6796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006797 Supported in default-server: No
6798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006799track [<proxy>/]<server>
6800 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6801 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6802 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6803 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6804 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006806 Supported in default-server: No
6807
6808weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006809 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6810 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6811 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006812 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6813 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6814 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6815 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6816 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6817 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006819 Supported in default-server: Yes
6820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006821
68226. HTTP header manipulation
6823---------------------------
6824
6825In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6826response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6827request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6828which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6829against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6830to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6831passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6832headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6833never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6834
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006835There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6836(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6837rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6838messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6839in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006840happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006841add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6842normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006844This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6845in section 4.2 :
6846
6847 - reqadd <string>
6848 - reqallow <search>
6849 - reqiallow <search>
6850 - reqdel <search>
6851 - reqidel <search>
6852 - reqdeny <search>
6853 - reqideny <search>
6854 - reqpass <search>
6855 - reqipass <search>
6856 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6857 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6858 - reqtarpit <search>
6859 - reqitarpit <search>
6860 - rspadd <string>
6861 - rspdel <search>
6862 - rspidel <search>
6863 - rspdeny <search>
6864 - rspideny <search>
6865 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6866 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6867
6868With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6869is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6870parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6871prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6872Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6873
6874 \t for a tab
6875 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6876 \n for a new line (LF)
6877 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6878 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6879 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6880 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6881 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6882
6883The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6884portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6885above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6886regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
68879 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6888is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6889
6890The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6891after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6892
6893Notes related to these keywords :
6894---------------------------------
6895 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6896 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6897 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6898
6899 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6900 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6901 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6902
6903 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6904 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6905 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6906 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6907 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6908
6909 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6910 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6911 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6912 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6913 useless headers before adding new ones.
6914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006915 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006916 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6917
6918 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6919 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6920 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6921
6922 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6923 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006924 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006925
6926
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010069277. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6928------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006929
6930The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6931content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6932from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6933simple :
6934
6935 - define test criteria with sets of values
6936 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6937
6938The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6939
6940In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6941
6942 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6943
6944This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6945Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6946and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6947an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6948of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6949
6950ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6951'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6952which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6953
6954There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6955performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6956
6957The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6958
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006959 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6960 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006961 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6962
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006963The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6964specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6965possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006966multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6967be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6968needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6969space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6970match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6971lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6972duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6973to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6974instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006975
6976 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6977
6978In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6979the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6980case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6981too.
6982
6983Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6984a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6985ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006987Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006988
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006989 - integers or integer ranges
6990 - strings
6991 - regular expressions
6992 - IP addresses and networks
6993
6994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069957.1. Matching integers
6996----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006997
6998Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6999that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7000expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7001may be omitted.
7002
7003For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7004unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7005representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7006
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007007As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7008two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7009instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7010ranges and operators.
7011
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007012For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007013operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7014Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7015of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007017Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007018
7019 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7020 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7021 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7022 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7023 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007025For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007026
7027 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7028
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007029This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7030
7031 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070347.2. Matching strings
7035---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007036
7037String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7038exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7039characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7040string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7041to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007042before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007043
7044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070457.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7046-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007047
7048Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7049they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7050possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7051passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7052the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007053the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7054match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007055
7056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070577.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7058----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007059
7060IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7061netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7062within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007063host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007064difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7065at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7066does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7067parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007068
7069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070707.5. Available matching criteria
7071--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070737.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7074------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007075
7076A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7077analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7078addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7079
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007080always_false
7081 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7082 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7083
7084always_true
7085 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7086 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7087
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007088avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007089avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007090 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7091 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7092 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7093 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7094 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7095 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7096 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7097 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7098 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7099 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7100 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007101
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007102be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007103be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007104 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7105 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7106 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7107 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7108 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007109
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007110be_id <integer>
7111 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7112 backend it was called.
7113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007114be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007115be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007116 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7117 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7118 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7119 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7120 sucking of an online dictionary).
7121
7122 Example :
7123 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7124 backend dynamic
7125 mode http
7126 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7127 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007128
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007129connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007130connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007131 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007132 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007133 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7134
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007135 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7136 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007137
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007138 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007139 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7140 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7141 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7142 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7143 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007144 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007145
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007146 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7147 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7148 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7149 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007151dst <ip_address>
7152 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7153 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007155dst_conn <integer>
7156 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7157 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7158 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7159 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7160 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7161 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7162
7163dst_port <integer>
7164 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7165 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7166
7167fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007168fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007169 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7170 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7171 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7172 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7173 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7174 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7175 criteria.
7176
7177fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007178 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007179 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007180
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007181fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007182fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007183 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7184 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7185 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7186 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7187 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7188 the rate to go down below the limit.
7189
7190 Example :
7191 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7192 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7193 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7194 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7195 frontend mail
7196 bind :25
7197 mode tcp
7198 maxconn 100
7199 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7200 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7201 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7202 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007203
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007204nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007205nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007206 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7207 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7208 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7209 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7210 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007211
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007212queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007213queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007214 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7215 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7216 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7217 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7218 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7219 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7220 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007222sc1_bytes_in_rate
7223sc2_bytes_in_rate
7224 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7225 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7226 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7227
7228sc1_bytes_out_rate
7229sc2_bytes_out_rate
7230 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7231 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7232 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7233
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007234sc1_clr_gpc0
7235sc2_clr_gpc0
7236 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7237 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7238 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7239 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7240 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7241 was verified :
7242
7243 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7244 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7245 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7246 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7247 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7248 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7249 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007251sc1_conn_cnt
7252sc2_conn_cnt
7253 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7254 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7255
7256sc1_conn_cur
7257sc2_conn_cur
7258 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7259 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7260 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7261
7262sc1_conn_rate
7263sc2_conn_rate
7264 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7265 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7266 See also src_conn_rate.
7267
7268sc1_get_gpc0
7269sc2_get_gpc0
7270 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7271 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7272
7273sc1_http_err_cnt
7274sc2_http_err_cnt
7275 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7276 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7277 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7278
7279sc1_http_err_rate
7280sc2_http_err_rate
7281 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7282 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7283 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7284 src_http_err_rate.
7285
7286sc1_http_req_cnt
7287sc2_http_req_cnt
7288 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7289 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7290 src_http_req_cnt.
7291
7292sc1_http_req_rate
7293sc2_http_req_rate
7294 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7295 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7296 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7297 src_http_req_rate.
7298
7299sc1_inc_gpc0
7300sc2_inc_gpc0
7301 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7302 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7303 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7304 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7305 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7306 when a first ACL was verified :
7307
7308 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7309 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7310 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7311
7312sc1_kbytes_in
7313sc2_kbytes_in
7314 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7315 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7316 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7317 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7318
7319sc1_kbytes_out
7320sc2_kbytes_out
7321 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7322 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7323 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7324 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7325
7326sc1_sess_cnt
7327sc2_sess_cnt
7328 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7329 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7330 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7331 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7332 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7333 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7334
7335sc1_sess_rate
7336sc2_sess_rate
7337 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7338 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7339 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7340 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7341 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7342 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7343
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007344so_id <integer>
7345 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7346
7347src <ip_address>
7348 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7349 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7350 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7351
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007352src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007353src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007354 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7355 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7356 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007357 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007358
7359src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007360src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007361 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7362 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7363 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007364 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007365
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007366src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7367src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7368 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7369 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7370 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7371 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7372 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7373 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7374
7375 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7376 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7377 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7378 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7379 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7380 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7381 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7382
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007383src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007384src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007385 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7386 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7387 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007388 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007389
7390src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007391src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007392 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7393 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7394 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007395 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007396
7397src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007398src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007399 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7400 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7401 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007402 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007403
7404src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007405src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007406 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7407 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7408 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007409 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007410
7411src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007412src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007413 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7414 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7415 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007416 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007417
7418src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007419src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007420 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7421 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7422 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7423 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007424 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007425
7426src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007427src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007428 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7429 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7430 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007432
7433src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007434src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007435 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7436 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7437 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7438 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007439 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007440
7441src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007442src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007443 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7444 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7445 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7446 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7447 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7448 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7449
7450 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7451 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007452 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007453
7454src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007455src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007456 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7457 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7458 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7459 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007460 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007461
7462src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007463src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007464 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7465 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7466 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7467 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007468 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007469
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007470src_port <integer>
7471 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007472
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007473src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007474src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007475 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7476 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7477 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7478 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007479 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007480
7481src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007482src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007483 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7484 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7485 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7486 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007488
7489src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007490src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007491 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007492 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7493 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007494 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7495 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7496 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007497 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007498
7499 Example :
7500 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7501 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7502 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7503 listen ssh
7504 bind :22
7505 mode tcp
7506 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007507 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007508 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7509 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7510
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007511srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007512 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7513 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7514 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7515 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7516
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007517srv_id <integer>
7518 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7519
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007520srv_is_up(<server>)
7521srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7522 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7523 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7524 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7525 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7526 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7527 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7528 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7529 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7530
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007531table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007532table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007533 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7534 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7535
7536table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007537table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007538 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7539 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7540 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020075437.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7544---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007545
7546A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7547during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7549keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007550
7551req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007552 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007553 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7554 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7555 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7556 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7557 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7558 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7559
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007560req_proto_http
7561 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7562 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007563 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007564 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7565 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7566
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007567req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007568req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007569 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7570 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7571 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7572 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7573 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7574 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7575 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7576 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7577
7578req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007579req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007580 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7581 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7582 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7583 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7584 cookies.
7585
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007586req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7587 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7588 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7589 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7590 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7591 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7592 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7593 with TCP request content inspection.
7594
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007595req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7596 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7597 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7598 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7599 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7600
7601rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7602 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7603 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7604 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7605 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7606
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007607wait_end
7608 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7609 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7610 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7611 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7612 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7613 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7614 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7615 inspection.
7616
7617 Examples :
7618 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7619 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7620 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7621
7622 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7623 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7624 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7625 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7626 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7627 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7628 tcp-request content reject
7629
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076317.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7632--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007633
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007634A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007635application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7636read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7637than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7638
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007639hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007640hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007641 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7642 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7643 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7644 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7645 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7646
7647 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7648 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7649 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7650
7651 hdr(Connection) -i close
7652
7653hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007654hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007655 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7656 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7657 response headers sent by the server.
7658
7659hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007660hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007661 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7662 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7663 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7664 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7665 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7666 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7667 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7668
7669hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007670hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007671 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7672 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7673 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7674 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7675 headers sent by the server.
7676
7677hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007678hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007679 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7680 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7681 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7682 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7683 server.
7684
7685hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007686hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007687 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7688 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7689 response headers sent by the server.
7690
7691hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007692hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007693 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7694 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7695 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7696 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7697
7698hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007699hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007700 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7701 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7702 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7703 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7704 response headers sent by the server.
7705
7706hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007707hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007708 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7709 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7710 response headers sent by the server.
7711
7712hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007713hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007714 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7715 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7716 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7717 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7718
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007719http_auth(<userlist>)
7720http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007721 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7722 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7723 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7724 of specified groups.
7725
7726 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7727
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007728http_req_first
7729 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7730 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7731 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7732 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007734method <string>
7735 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7736 already check for most common methods.
7737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007738path <string>
7739 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7740 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7741 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7742
7743path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007744 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7745 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007746
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007747path_dir <string>
7748 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7749 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7750 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7751 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7752
7753path_dom <string>
7754 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7755 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7756 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7757
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007758path_end <string>
7759 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7760 control file name extension.
7761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007762path_reg <regex>
7763 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7764 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7765 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7766
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007767path_sub <string>
7768 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7769 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7770 "path_dir".
7771
7772req_ver <string>
7773 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7774 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7775
7776status <integer>
7777 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7778 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7779 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7780
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007781url <string>
7782 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7783 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7784
7785url_beg <string>
7786 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7787 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007789url_dir <string>
7790 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7791 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7792 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7793 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7794
7795url_dom <string>
7796 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7797 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7798 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7799
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007800url_end <string>
7801 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7802 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007803
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007804url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007805 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7806 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007807 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007808
7809url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007810 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7811 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007812 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007813 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007815url_reg <regex>
7816 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7817 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7818 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007819
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007820url_sub <string>
7821 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7822 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078257.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7826---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007828Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7829every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007830order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007832ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7833---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007834FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007835HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007836HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7837HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007838HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7839HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7840HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7841HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7842LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007843METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7844METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7845METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7846METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7847METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7848METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007849RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007850REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007851TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007852WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7853---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007854
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078567.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7857----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007859Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7860combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007862 - AND (implicit)
7863 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7864 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007866A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007870Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7871indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007873For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7874"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7875requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7876is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007878 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7879 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7880 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7881 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007883To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7884and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007886 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7887 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7888 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7889 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007891 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7892 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7893 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7894 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007895
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007896It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7897expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7898be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7899the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7900
7901 The following rule :
7902
7903 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7904 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7905
7906 Can also be written that way :
7907
7908 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7909
7910It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7911to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7912simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7913sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7914good use is the following :
7915
7916 With named ACLs :
7917
7918 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7919 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7920 monitor fail if site_dead
7921
7922 With anonymous ACLs :
7923
7924 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007926See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007927
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007928
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079297.8. Pattern extraction
7930-----------------------
7931
7932The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7933response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7934for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7935
7936All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7937"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7938begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7939arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7940much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7941equivalent used in ACLs.
7942
7943The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7944
7945 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007946 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7947 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7948 according to RFC 4291.
7949
7950 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
7951 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007952
7953 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7954 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7955 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007956 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7957 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7958 according to RFC 4291.
7959
7960 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
7961 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7962 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007963 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007964
7965 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7966 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7967 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7968 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7969 type integer and only works with such tables.
7970
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007971 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007972 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7973 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7974 x-forwarded-for header.
7975
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007976 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007977 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7978 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7979 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7980 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007981
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007982 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007983 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7984 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7985 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7986 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7987 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7988 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7989 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7990 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7991
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007992 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007993 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007994 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007995 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7996 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7997 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7998
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007999 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008000 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8001 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8002 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8003 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8004
8005 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8006 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8007 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8008 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8009 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8010 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8011 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8012
8013 Example :
8014 listen tse-farm
8015 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8016 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8017 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8018 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8019 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8020 persist rdp-cookie
8021 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8022 # This is only useful makes sense if
8023 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8024 stick-table type string size 204800
8025 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8026 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8027 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8028
8029 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8030 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8031
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008032 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008033 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8034 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8035 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8036 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8037 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8038 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8039 restarts.
8040
8041 See also : "appsession"
8042
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008043 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008044 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8045 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8046 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8047 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8048 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8049
8050 See also : "appsession"
8051
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008052
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008053The currently available list of transformations include :
8054
8055 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8056 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8057 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8058
8059 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8060 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8061 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8062
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008063 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008064 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8065 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8066 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8067 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8068
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080708. Logging
8071----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008073One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8074provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8075very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8076provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8077state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008078to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008079headers.
8080
8081In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8082about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8083send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8084
8085 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8086 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8087 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8088 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8089 at the termination.
8090
8091The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8092allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8093as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8094while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8095real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8096delay.
8097
8098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080998.1. Log levels
8100---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008101
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008102TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008103source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008104HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8105in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8106track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8107syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8108about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008109
8110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081118.2. Log formats
8112----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008113
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008114HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008115and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8116slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8117options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008118
8119 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8120 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8121 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8122 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8123 extents.
8124
8125 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8126 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8127 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8128 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8129 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8130
8131 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8132 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8133 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8134 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8135 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8136
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008137 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8138 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8139 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8140 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008142Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8143specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8144field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8145servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8146always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8147identifier.
8148
8149Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8150 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8151 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8152 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8153 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8154
8155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081568.2.1. Default log format
8157-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008158
8159This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8160as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8161format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8162
8163 Example :
8164 listen www
8165 mode http
8166 log global
8167 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8168
8169 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8170 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8171 (www/HTTP)
8172
8173 Field Format Extract from the example above
8174 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8175 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8176 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8177 4 'to' to
8178 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8179 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8180
8181Detailed fields description :
8182 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8183 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8184 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8185 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8186 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8187 and processed the connection.
8188 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008190In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8191"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8192connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008194It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8195will eventually disappear.
8196
8197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081988.2.2. TCP log format
8199---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008200
8201The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8202is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8203information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8204counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8205emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8206environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8207the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8208sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008209specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8210not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8211fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8212marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008213
8214 Example :
8215 frontend fnt
8216 mode tcp
8217 option tcplog
8218 log global
8219 default_backend bck
8220
8221 backend bck
8222 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8223
8224 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8225 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8226 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8227
8228 Field Format Extract from the example above
8229 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8230 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8231 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8232 4 frontend_name fnt
8233 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8234 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8235 7 bytes_read* 212
8236 8 termination_state --
8237 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8238 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8239
8240Detailed fields description :
8241 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008242 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8243 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8244 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8245 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8246 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008247
8248 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008249 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8250 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8251 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008252
8253 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8254 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8255 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8256 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8257
8258 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8259 and processed the connection.
8260
8261 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8262 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8263 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8264 applications.
8265
8266 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8267 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8268 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8269 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8270 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8271
8272 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8273 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8274 See "Timers" below for more details.
8275
8276 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8277 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8278 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8279 "Timers" below for more details.
8280
8281 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8282 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8283 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8284 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8285 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8286 details.
8287
8288 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8289 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8290 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8291 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8292 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8293
8294 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8295 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8296 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8297 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8298 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8299 for more details.
8300
8301 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8302 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8303 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8304 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8305 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008306 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008307
8308 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8309 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8310 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8311 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8312 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8313 caused by a denial of service attack.
8314
8315 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8316 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8317 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8318 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8319 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8320 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8321 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8322 denial of service attack.
8323
8324 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8325 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8326 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8327 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8328 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8329 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8330 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8331 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8332 be processed than on other servers.
8333
8334 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8335 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8336 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8337 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8338 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8339 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8340 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8341 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8342 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8343 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8344 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8345 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8346 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8347
8348 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8349 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8350 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8351 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8352 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8353 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8354 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8355 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8356
8357 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8358 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8359 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8360 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8361 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8362 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8363 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8364 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8365 occurs.
8366
8367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083688.2.3. HTTP log format
8369----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008370
8371The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8372is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8373the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8374are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8375emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8376generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8377"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8378which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008379frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8380is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008381
8382Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8383slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8384with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8385
8386 Example :
8387 frontend http-in
8388 mode http
8389 option httplog
8390 log global
8391 default_backend bck
8392
8393 backend static
8394 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8395
8396 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8397 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8398 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008399 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008400
8401 Field Format Extract from the example above
8402 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8403 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8404 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8405 4 frontend_name http-in
8406 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8407 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8408 7 status_code 200
8409 8 bytes_read* 2750
8410 9 captured_request_cookie -
8411 10 captured_response_cookie -
8412 11 termination_state ----
8413 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8414 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8415 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8416 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8417 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008419
8420Detailed fields description :
8421 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008422 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8423 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8424 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8425 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8426 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008427
8428 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008429 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8430 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8431 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008432
8433 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8434 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8435 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8436 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8437 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8438
8439 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8440 and processed the connection.
8441
8442 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8443 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8444 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8445
8446 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8447 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8448 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8449 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8450 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8451 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8452
8453 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8454 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8455 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8456 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8457 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8458 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8459
8460 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8461 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8462 See "Timers" below for more details.
8463
8464 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8465 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8466 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8467 below for more details.
8468
8469 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8470 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8471 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8472 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8473 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8474 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8475 for more details.
8476
8477 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8478 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8479 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8480 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8481 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8482 details.
8483
8484 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8485 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8486 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8487
8488 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8489 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8490 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8491 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8492 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8493 overflowing.
8494
8495 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8496 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8497 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8498 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8499 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8500 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8501 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8502 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8503
8504 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8505 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8506 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8507 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8508 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8509 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8510 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8511 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8512
8513 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8514 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8515 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8516 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8517 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8518 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8519 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8520
8521 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8522 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8523 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8524 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8525 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008526 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008527 system.
8528
8529 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8530 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8531 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8532 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8533 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8534 caused by a denial of service attack.
8535
8536 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8537 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8538 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8539 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8540 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8541 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8542 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8543 denial of service attack.
8544
8545 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8546 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8547 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8548 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8549 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8550 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8551 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8552 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8553 processed than on other servers.
8554
8555 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8556 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8557 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8558 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8559 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8560 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8561 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8562 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8563 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8564 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8565 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8566 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8567 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8568
8569 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8570 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8571 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8572 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8573 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8574 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8575 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8576 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8577
8578 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8579 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8580 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8581 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8582 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8583 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8584 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8585 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8586 occurs.
8587
8588 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8589 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8590 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8591 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8592 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8593 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8594 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8595 cookies" below for more details.
8596
8597 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8598 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8599 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8600 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8601 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8602 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8603 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8604 and cookies" below for more details.
8605
8606 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8607 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8608 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8609 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8610 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8611 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8612 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8613 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8614
8615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086168.3. Advanced logging options
8617-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008618
8619Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8620just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8621options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8622for more information about their usage.
8623
8624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8626------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008627
8628It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8629haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8630commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8631monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8632ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8633
8634 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8635 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8636 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8637 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8638
8639 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8640 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8641 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8642 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8643 such as other load-balancers.
8644
8645 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8646 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8647 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8648
8649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8651----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008652
8653The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8654what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8655or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8656"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8657just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8658log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8659after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8660is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8661with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8662with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8663
8664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8666------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008667
8668Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8669for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8670"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8671retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8672raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8673a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8674file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8675you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8676"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8677
8678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8680--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008681
8682Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8683multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8684them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8685"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8686logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8687error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8688and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8689too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8690useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8691alternative.
8692
8693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086948.4. Timing events
8695------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008696
8697Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8698reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8699the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8700frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8701mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8702
8703 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8704 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8705 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8706 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8707 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8708
8709 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8710 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8711 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8712 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8713 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8714
8715 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8716 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8717 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8718 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8719 connection never established.
8720
8721 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8722 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8723 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8724 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8725 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8726 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8727 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8728 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8729 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8730 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8731 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8732
8733 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8734 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8735 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8736 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8737 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8738
8739 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8740
8741 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8742 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8743 negative.
8744
8745These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8746protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8747that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008748due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008749close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8750session has been aborted on timeout.
8751
8752Most common cases :
8753
8754 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8755 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8756 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8757 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8758 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8759 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8760 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8761 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8762 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008763 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8764 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8765 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008766
8767 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8768 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8769 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8770 of ms on remote networks.
8771
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008772 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8773 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8774 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008775
8776 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8777 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8778 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8779 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8780 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8781 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8782 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8783 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8784 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8785 to the server until another one is released.
8786
8787Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8788
8789 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8790 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8791 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8792
8793 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8794 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8795 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8796
8797 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8798 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8799 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8800 flags.
8801
8802 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8803 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8804 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8805 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8806 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8807 the client connection was maintained open.
8808
8809 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8810 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8811 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8812 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8813
8814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088158.5. Session state at disconnection
8816-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008817
8818TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8819"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
88202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8821each of which has a special meaning :
8822
8823 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8824 session to terminate :
8825
8826 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8827
8828 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8829 server explicitly refused it.
8830
8831 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8832 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8833 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8834 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8835 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8836 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8837
8838 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8839 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8840 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8841 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8842 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8843
8844 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8845 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8846 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8847 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8848 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8849
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09008850 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
8851 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
8852
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008853 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8854 send or receive data.
8855
8856 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8857 send or receive data.
8858
8859 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8860 with nothing left in the buffers.
8861
8862 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8863
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008864 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008865 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8866
8867 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8868 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8869 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8870 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8871 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8872
8873 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8874 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8875
8876 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8877 server (HTTP only).
8878
8879 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8880
8881 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8882 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8883 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8884
8885 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8886 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8887 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8888
8889 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8890
8891 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8892 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8893
8894 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8895 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8896 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8897
8898 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8899 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008900 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8901 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008902
8903 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8904 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8905 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8906 another server.
8907
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008908 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008909 server.
8910
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008911 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8912 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8913 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8914 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8915
8916 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8917 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8918 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8919 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008921 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8922
8923 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8924 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8925
8926 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8927
8928 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8929 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8930 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8931
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008932 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8933 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8934 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8935 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8936 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008938 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8939
8940 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8941 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8942
8943 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8944
8945 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8946
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008947The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8948was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008949helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8950starvation, attacks, etc...
8951
8952The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8953alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8954easier finding and understanding.
8955
8956 Flags Reason
8957
8958 -- Normal termination.
8959
8960 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8961 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8962 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8963 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8964
8965 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8966 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8967 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8968 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8969 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8970 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008972 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8973 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8974 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8975
8976 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8977 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8978 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8979
8980 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8981 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8982 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8983 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8984 the server takes too long to respond.
8985
8986 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8987 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8988 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8989 long a time to respond.
8990
8991 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8992 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8993 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8994 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8995 and the client.
8996
8997 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8998 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8999 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9000 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9001 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9002 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9003
9004 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9005 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009006 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9007 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9008 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9009 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009011 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009012 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9013 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9014 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9015 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9016 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9017
9018 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9019 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9020 503 or 504 here.
9021
9022 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9023 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9024 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9025 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9026 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9027
9028 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9029 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009030 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009031 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9032 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9033
9034 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9035 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9036 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9037 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9038 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9039 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9040 between haproxy and the server.
9041
9042 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9043 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9044 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9045 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9046 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9047 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9048 solution is to fix the application.
9049
9050 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9051 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9052 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9053 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9054 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9055 external attacks.
9056
9057 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9058 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9059 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9060 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9061 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9062
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009063 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9064 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9065 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9066 the client.
9067
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009068 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9069 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9070 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9071 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009072 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9073 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9074 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9075 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9076 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009077
9078 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9079 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9080 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9081 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9082
9083 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9084 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9085 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9086 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9087
9088 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9089 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9090 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9091 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009093The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9094persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9095important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9096re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9097
9098 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9099
9100 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9101 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9102 set on a GET request.
9103
9104 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9105 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9106 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9107 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9108
9109 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9110 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9111 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9112
9113 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9114 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9115 already got a cookie.
9116
9117 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9118 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9119 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9120 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9121 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9122
9123 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9124 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9125 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9126
9127 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9128 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9129 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9130
9131 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9132 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9133
9134 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9135 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9136 then advertised in the response.
9137
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091398.6. Non-printable characters
9140-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009141
9142In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9143consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9144converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9145prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9146being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9147escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9148is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9149'}' when logging headers.
9150
9151Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9152issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9153containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9154
9155Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9156the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9157performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9158
9159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091608.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9161---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009162
9163Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9164achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009165section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009166cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9167the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9168the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009169locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009170not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9171user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9172a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9173wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9174
9175 Examples :
9176 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9177 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9178
9179 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9180 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9181
9182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091838.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9184---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009185
9186Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9187proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9188the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9189server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9190
9191Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9192response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009193section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009194
9195It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009196time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9197appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009198are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9199and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9200follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9201request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9202in the logs.
9203
9204 Example :
9205 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9206 listen proxy-out
9207 mode http
9208 option httplog
9209 option logasap
9210 log global
9211 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9212
9213 # log the name of the virtual server
9214 capture request header Host len 20
9215
9216 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9217 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9218
9219 # log the beginning of the referrer
9220 capture request header Referer len 20
9221
9222 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9223 capture response header Server len 20
9224
9225 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9226 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9227
9228 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9229 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9230
9231 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9232 capture response header Via len 20
9233
9234 # log the URL location during a redirection
9235 capture response header Location len 20
9236
9237 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9238 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9239 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9240 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9241 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9242
9243 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9244 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9245 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9246 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009247 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009248
9249 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9250 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9251 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9252 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9253 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009254 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009255
9256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092578.9. Examples of logs
9258---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009259
9260These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9261them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9262reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9263
9264 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9265 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9266 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9267
9268 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9269 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9270
9271 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9272 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9273 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9274
9275 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9276 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9277
9278 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9279 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9280 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9281
9282 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009283 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009284 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9285 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9286
9287 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9288 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9289 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9290
9291 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9292 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9293 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9294 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9295 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9296 to return the 502 and not the server.
9297
9298 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009299 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009300
9301 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9302 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9303 Nothing was sent to any server.
9304
9305 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9306 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9307
9308 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9309 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9310 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9311 send a 408 return code to the client.
9312
9313 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9314 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9315
9316 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9317 5 seconds ("c----").
9318
9319 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9320 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009321 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009322
9323 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009324 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009325 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9326 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9327 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9328 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9329 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009330
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093329. Statistics and monitoring
9333----------------------------
9334
9335It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9336mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9337CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9338Unix socket.
9339
9340
93419.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009342---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009343
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009344The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9345page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009347 0. pxname: proxy name
9348 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9349 for server)
9350 2. qcur: current queued requests
9351 3. qmax: max queued requests
9352 4. scur: current sessions
9353 5. smax: max sessions
9354 6. slim: sessions limit
9355 7. stot: total sessions
9356 8. bin: bytes in
9357 9. bout: bytes out
9358 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009359 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009360 12. ereq: request errors
9361 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009362 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009363 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9364 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009365 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009366 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9367 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9368 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9369 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9370 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9371 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9372 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9373 25. qlimit: queue limit
9374 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9375 27. iid: unique proxy id
9376 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9377 29. throttle: warm up status
9378 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9379 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009380 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009381 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9382 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9383 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009384 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009385 UNK -> unknown
9386 INI -> initializing
9387 SOCKERR -> socket error
9388 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9389 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9390 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9391 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9392 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9393 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9394 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9395 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9396 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9397 disable-on-404
9398 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9399 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9400 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009401 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9402 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009403 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9404 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9405 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9406 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9407 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9408 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009409 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9410 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9411 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9412 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009413 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9414 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009415
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094179.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009418-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009419
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009420The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009421must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9422is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9423a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9424risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9425followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9426given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9427then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9428to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009429
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009430It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9431on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9432own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009433
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009434clear counters
9435 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9436 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9437 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9438 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9439 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9440
9441clear counters all
9442 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9443 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9444 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9445
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009446clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9447 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9448
9449 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9450 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9451 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9452 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9453 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9454 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9455
9456 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9457
9458 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9459 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9460 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9461 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9462 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9463 the ACLs :
9464
9465 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9466 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9467 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9468 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9469 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9470 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9471
9472 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009473 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9474 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009475
9476 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009477 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009478 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009479 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9480 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9481 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9482 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009483
9484 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9485
9486 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009487 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009488 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9489 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009490 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9491 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9492 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009493
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009494disable server <backend>/<server>
9495 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9496 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9497 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9498 during the maintenance.
9499
9500 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9501 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9502
9503 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009504 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009505
9506 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9507 level "admin".
9508
9509enable server <backend>/<server>
9510 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9511 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9512
9513 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009514 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009515
9516 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9517 level "admin".
9518
9519get weight <backend>/<server>
9520 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9521 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9522 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9523 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9524 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009525 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009526
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009527help
9528 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9529 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009530
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009531prompt
9532 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9533 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9534 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9535 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9536 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9537 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9538 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9539 command.
9540
9541quit
9542 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009543
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009544set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9545 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9546 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9547 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9548 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9549 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9550 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9551 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9552
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009553set timeout cli <delay>
9554 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9555 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9556 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9557
9558set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9559 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9560 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9561 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9562 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9563 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9564 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9565 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9566 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9567 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9568 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9569 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9570 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9571 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009572 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009573
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009574show errors [<iid>]
9575 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9576 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009577 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9578 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9579 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009580
9581 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9582 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9583 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9584 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9585 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9586 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9587 are reported too.
9588
9589 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9590 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9591 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9592 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9593 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9594 code.
9595
9596 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9597 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9598 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9599 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9600 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9601 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9602 line.
9603
9604 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009605 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9606 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009607 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9608 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9609
9610 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9611 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9612 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9613 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9614 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9615 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9616 00204+ minal\r\n
9617 00211 \r\n
9618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009619 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009620 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9621 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9622 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9623 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9624 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9625 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009626
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009627show info
9628 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9629
9630show sess
9631 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009632 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9633 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9634
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009635show sess <id>
9636 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9637 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9638 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9639 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9640 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9641 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009642
9643show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9644 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9645 possible to dump only selected items :
9646 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9647 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9648 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9649 for example:
9650 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9651 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9652 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9653
9654 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009655 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9656 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009657 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9658 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9659 Nbproc: 1
9660 Process_num: 1
9661 (...)
9662
9663 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9664 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9665 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9666 (...)
9667 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9668
9669 $
9670
9671 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9672 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9673 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9674 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009675 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009676
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009677show table
9678 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9679 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9680 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9681 entries currently in use.
9682
9683 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009684 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009685 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
9686 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009687
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009688show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009689 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9690 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9691 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009692 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9693
9694 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9695 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9696 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9697 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9698 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9699
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009700 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9701 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9702 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9703 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9704 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9705 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9706
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009707
9708 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009709 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9710 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009711
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009712 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009713 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009714 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009715 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9716 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9717 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9718 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009719
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009720 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009721 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009722 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9723 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009724
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009725 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9726 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009727 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009728 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9729 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009730
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009731 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9732 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009733 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009734 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9735 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9736
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009737 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9738 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9739 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9740 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9741 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9742
9743 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9744 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9745 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009746 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9747 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009748 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9749 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009751/*
9752 * Local variables:
9753 * fill-column: 79
9754 * End:
9755 */